Download SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide

Transcript
SPT 1800 Series
Product Reference Guide
SPT 1800 Series
Product Reference Guide
72-51337-06
Revision A
March 2003
 2001-3 by Symbol Technologies, Inc. All rights reserved.
No part of this publication may be reproduced or used in any form, or by any electrical or
mechanical means, without permission in writing from Symbol. This includes electronic or
mechanical means, such as photocopying, recording, or information storage and retrieval
systems. The material in this manual is subject to change without notice.
The software is provided strictly on an “as is” basis. All software, including firmware,
furnished to the user is on a licensed basis. Symbol grants to the user a non-transferable
and non-exclusive license to use each software or firmware program delivered hereunder
(licensed program). Except as noted below, such license may not be assigned,
sublicensed, or otherwise transferred by the user without prior written consent of Symbol.
No right to copy a licensed program in whole or in part is granted, except as permitted under
copyright law. The user shall not modify, merge, or incorporate any form or portion of a
licensed program with other program material, create a derivative work from a licensed
program, or use a licensed program in a network without written permission from Symbol.
The user agrees to maintain Symbol’s copyright notice on the licensed programs delivered
hereunder, and to include the same on any authorized copies it makes, in whole or in part.
The user agrees not to decompile, disassemble, decode, or reverse engineer any licensed
program delivered to the user or any portion thereof.
Symbol reserves the right to make changes to any software or product to improve reliability,
function, or design.
Symbol does not assume any product liability arising out of, or in connection with, the
application or use of any product, circuit, or application described herein.
No license is granted, either expressly or by implication, estoppel, or otherwise under any
Symbol Technologies, Inc., intellectual property rights. An implied license only exists for
equipment, circuits, and subsystems contained in Symbol products.
Symbol and the Symbol logo are registered trademarks of Symbol Technologies, Inc. Other
product names mentioned in this manual may be trademarks or registered trademarks of
their respective companies and are hereby acknowledged.
Symbol Technologies, Inc.
One Symbol Plaza
Holtsville, New York 11742-1300
http://www.symbol.com
ii
Contents
About This Guide
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xi
Chapter Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xi
Notational Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Related Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Service Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Symbol Support Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
Chapter 1. Getting Started
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Unpacking the Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Parts of the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Getting Started. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Installing the Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Charging the Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
Starting the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
Configuring the Spectrum24 Network (SPT 184x only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
Configuring the Wide Area Network (SPT 1833 only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
Using the SPT 1800. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Using the Power Button/Backlight Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Using the Contrast Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Writing with the Stylus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Tapping Versus Clicking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
Using the Onscreen Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
Icon Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
Cables and Cradles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
Synchronization/Charging Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
CRD1800-1000S Single-slot Serial Cradle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
CRD1700-4000S Four-slot Serial Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18
iii
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
CRD1700-1000M-1 Modem Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19
CRD1700-4000E Four-slot Ethernet Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20
Four-slot Charging Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21
VCD 1700/VCD X800Vehicle Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
VCA 3000 Vehicle Charging Adapter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
MSR 3000 Mag Stripe Reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
Using the MSR 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
Charging the Terminal’s Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
TRG 3000 Trigger Handle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
Replacing the Handstrap. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
System Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-31
Chapter 2. Network Setup
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Data Encryption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
WEP Encryption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Kerberos Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Configuring a Spectrum24 Connection
(SPT 184x Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
SPT 1842 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
SPT 1846 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Configuring a CDPD WAN Connection
(SPT 1833 Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Setup Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
Maintenance Screens and Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
Merlin Menu Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
Chapter 3. Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Applications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Changing the Applications Launcher Display Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Switching Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Setting Preferences for Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Displaying Applications by Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Writing Graffiti 2 with the Stylus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Practicing Graffiti 2 with the Memo Pad. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
General Guidelines for Graffiti 2 Writing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Using the On-Screen Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15
Using Application Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Using Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18
iv
Contents
Choosing a Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Graffiti 2 Menu Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Edit Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Choosing Fonts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Categories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Categories in Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Defining a New Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Renaming Categories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Attaching Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Marking Private Entries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Beaming Information to Other SPT 1800 Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scanning with the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-18
3-19
3-19
3-20
3-21
3-22
3-23
3-25
3-26
3-26
3-27
3-29
Chapter 4. Finding Information With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using the Find Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Phone Lookup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Phone Lookup Tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-3
4-3
4-4
4-5
Chapter 5. Applications: Calculator
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Opening the Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using the Calculator Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Calculator Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Calculator Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Recent Calculations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-3
5-3
5-3
5-3
5-4
5-5
Chapter 6. Applications: Date Book
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Opening the Date Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Using the Date Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Scheduling an Event. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Rescheduling an Event. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Setting an Alarm for an Event. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Scheduling Repeating Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Marking a Private Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Deleting an Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Changing the Date Book View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Working in Week View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Working in Month View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
Working in Agenda View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
v
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Date Book Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
Record Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19
Chapter 7. Applications: Address Book
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Opening the Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Address Book Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Creating an Address Book Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Deleting an Address Book Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Duplicating an Address Book Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Working with Address Book Entries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Beaming Address Entries to Other SPT 1800 Terminals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
Address Book Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Record Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
Chapter 8. Applications: Memo Pad
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
Opening the Memo Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
Creating a New Memo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4
Reviewing Memos. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Arranging Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Manually Arranging the Memo List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Choosing a Memo Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Marking a Private Memo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Deleting a Memo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Memo Pad Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Record Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
Chapter 9. Applications: To Do List
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Opening the To Do List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Working With To Do Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Setting Priority (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Checking Off a To Do Item . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
To Do Item Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
Choosing a To Do Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Setting a Due Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Marking a To Do Item Private . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
vi
Contents
Deleting a To Do Item. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
To Do Show Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
To Do List Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Record Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11
Chapter 10. Applications: HotSync®
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
The HotSync Process and the HotSync Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Performing a HotSync Operation for the First Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Using User Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
Using File Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
Conducting a Local HotSync Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Selecting HotSync Setup Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Customizing HotSync Application Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
Conducting a HotSync Operation via Modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Preparing Your Computer for a Modem HotSync Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Preparing Your SPT 1800 Terminal for a Modem HotSync Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15
Selecting the Conduits for a Modem HotSync Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16
Performing a HotSync Operation via Modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
Conducting Wireless HotSync Operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Setting Up for a Wireless HotSync. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Performing a Spectrum24 HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
Performing a CDPD HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20
Setting Up the Ethernet Cradle for HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
Installing NetSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
Creating a CRD1700-4000E Modem Sync Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22
Configuring the Remote Host PC for Use with the Ethernet Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
The Ethernet HotSync Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Chapter 11. Applications: ScoutSync Client
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overview of the ScoutSync Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring the ScoutSync Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Conduits for Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Performing a Synchronization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatically Synchronizing Using a Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing the Synchronization Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ScoutSync Client Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11-3
11-3
11-4
11-5
11-6
11-6
11-7
11-8
11-8
vii
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Chapter 12. Applications: AirBEAM
Chapter Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3
AirBEAM Package Builder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3
AirBEAM Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4
AirBEAM License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4
Configuring the AirBEAM Client. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4
Synchronizing with the Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9
Chapter 13. Applications: Preferences
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3
Buttons Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3
Pen Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
HotSync Buttons Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
Connection Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7
Digitizer Preferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Formats Preferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Country Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Time, Date, Week Start and Numbers Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
Date & Time Preference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
Setting the Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
Setting the Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
Setting the Time Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-12
General Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
Auto-Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
Stay On In Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
System, Alarm and Game Sounds. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Beam Receive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Kerberos Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Network Preferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Selecting a Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-15
Entering a User Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16
Entering a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16
Adding Connection Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-17
Connecting to Your Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20
Creating Additional Service Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20
Adding Detailed Information to a Service Template. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-21
Idle Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-22
Defining Primary and Secondary DNS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-23
IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-24
Creating a Login Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-25
Deleting a Service Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-27
viii
Contents
Network Preferences Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Service Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TCP/IP Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Owner Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ShortCuts Preferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Creating a ShortCut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing a ShortCut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deleting a ShortCut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Symbol Preferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trigger Wake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High Beep . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trigger Sled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13-27
13-27
13-28
13-28
13-29
13-30
13-30
13-31
13-31
13-32
13-32
13-32
13-32
Chapter 14. Applications: Security
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Assigning a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hiding Private Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Showing Private Entries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Masking Private Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Locking Your SPT 1800 Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing or Deleting a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Recovering from a Lost Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14-3
14-3
14-4
14-5
14-5
14-6
14-7
14-8
Chapter 15. Applications: Laser Scanner
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scanning with the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SScan Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SScan Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Demo Scan Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Demo Scan Menu Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scanning 1-D Bar Codes Using Demo Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Barcode Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scanning Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery Implications While Using the Laser Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15-3
15-3
15-3
15-3
15-4
15-6
15-7
15-7
15-8
15-9
Chapter 16. Installing and Removing Applications
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Removing Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Removing the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16-3
16-3
16-6
16-7
ix
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Chapter 17. Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-3
Displaying Online Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-3
Symbol Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
SPT 1800 Diagnostics Utility. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
System Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-5
Bar Code Scanner Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-6
Serial Port Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-7
Digitizer Alignment Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-8
System Diagnostics Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-8
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-9
Technical Support, Service and Repair. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-15
Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-15
Chapter 18. Maintaining Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-3
Caring for Your SPT 1800 Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-3
Battery Considerations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-3
Resetting Your SPT 1800 Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
Performing a Soft Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
Performing a Hard Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
Appendix A. Non-ASCII Characters for Login Scripts
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A-1
Use of ^char . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A-1
Carriage Return and Line Feed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A-1
Literal Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A-2
Examples: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A-2
Appendix B. Installing the Multi-Language Operating System
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B-1
Download the Operating System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B-1
Download the Desktop Software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B-1
Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B-2
Switching Between Languages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B-7
Index
Feedback
x
About This Guide
Introduction
The SPT 1800 product family is the next generation of pen-based, one-dimensional bar
code scanning, pocket-sized terminals which also offer a new ruggedized design,
rechargeable lithium-ion battery and optional wireless local and wide area networking
capability. The complete line of SPT 1800 products are based on the popular Palm
ComputingTM platform architecture, offering users a fast, friendly, and flexible interface for
data acquisition and management. The SPT 1800 consists of the following models:
SPT 1800 Performs 1-dimensional scanning and batch communication. Memory configuration: 4
MB ROM/8 MB RAM.
SPT 1833 Performs 1-dimensional scanning and uses the CDPD radio to perform wide area
wireless communication. Memory configuration: 4 MB ROM/8 MB RAM.
SPT 1842 Performs 1-dimensional scanning and uses the Symbol Spectrum24 radio to perform 2
MB local area wireless communication. Memory configuration: 4 MB ROM/8 MB RAM.
SPT 1846 Performs 1-dimensional scanning and uses the Symbol Spectrum24 radio to perform 11
MB local area wireless communication. Memory configuration: 4 MB ROM/8 MB RAM.
The SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide provides information about all the SPT
1800 Series terminals and its accessories.
xi
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Chapter Descriptions
Topics covered in this guide are as follows:
•
Chapter 1, Getting Started, explains the physical buttons and controls on your SPT
1800 terminal, how to install and charge the battery, start your SPT 1800 terminal
for the first time, and set up your Symbol Palm Terminal (SPT) Desktop software.
•
Chapter 2, Network Setup, explains how to set up your SPT 184x terminals for use
on Spectrum24 and SPT 1833 terminals for use on CDPD wireless networks,
respectively.
•
Chapter 3, Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal, explains how to open
applications, use the on-screen keyboard, write with the stylus and use common
features on your SPT 1800 terminal.
•
Chapter 4, Finding Information With Your SPT 1800 Terminal, explains how to
locate information on your SPT 1800 terminal with the Find command and the
Phone Lookup command.
•
Chapter 5, Applications: Calculator, explains the Calculator application, which
allows you to perform simple calculations on your SPT 1800.
•
Chapter 6, Applications: Date Book, covers the Date Book application, which
enables you to quickly and easily schedule appointments or any kind of activity
associated with a time and date.
•
Chapter 7, Applications: Address Book, explains the Address Book application,
which enables you to keep names, addresses, phone numbers and other
information about your personal or business contacts.
•
Chapter 8, Applications: Memo Pad, explains the Memo Pad application, which
provides a place to take notes not associated with Date Book, Address Book or To
Do items.
•
Chapter 9, Applications: To Do List, describes the To Do List application, which is
a convenient place to create reminders and prioritize the things that you have to do.
•
Chapter 10, Applications: HotSync®, describes the HotSync utility, which allows
you to synchronize data between the SPT 1800 and your computer.
•
Chapter 11, Applications: ScoutSync Client, describes the ScoutSyncTM
application, which enables you to connect your SPT 1800 terminal to a Scout
Server and transfer data between the ScoutSync Client and your company’s backend applications and databases.
xii
About This Guide
•
Chapter 12, Applications: AirBEAM, describes the AirBEAM application, which
allows specially designed software packages to be transferred between a host
server and Symbol wireless handheld devices.
•
Chapter 13, Applications: Preferences, describes the Preferences screens, which
enable you to customize the configuration options on your SPT 1800 terminal.
Included in this chapter are instructions on configuring your SPT 1800 terminal for
use in the Spectrum24 and CDPD environments.
•
Chapter 14, Applications: Security, covers the security options available for
protecting your SPT 1800 from unauthorized users.
•
Chapter 15, Applications: Laser Scanner, covers laser scanner applications and
the proper methods for scanning 1- and 2-dimensional bar codes.
•
Chapter 16, Installing and Removing Applications, explains how to install and
remove applications on your SPT 1800 terminal and how to remove the Symbol
Palm Terminal (SPT) Desktop software from your computer.
•
Chapter 17, Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal, describes methods for
troubleshooting problems with the SPT 1800, and contact phone numbers for
technical support.
•
Chapter 18, Maintaining Your SPT 1800 Terminal, provides information to help you
take proper care of your SPT 1800 terminal and prolong battery life. This chapter
also discusses how to reset your SPT 1800 terminal.
•
Appendix A, Non-ASCII Characters for Login Scripts, provides information to
enable you to create custom login scripts that require non-ASCII characters. This
information is for advanced users only.
•
Appendix B, Installing the Multi-Language Operating System, provides information
on how to download and flash the multi-language operating system.
Notational Conventions
This document uses these conventions:
•
“Terminal” refers to any model of SPT 1800.
•
“User” refers to anyone using an application on the SPT 1800.
•
“You” refers to the End User, System Administrator or Technical Support person
using this manual as a reference to install, configure, operate, maintain and
troubleshoot the SPT 1800.
•
Italics are used to highlight specific items in the general text, and to identify
chapters and sections in this and related documents.
xiii
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
•
Bullets indicate:
•
lists of alternatives or action items.
•
lists of required steps that are not necessarily sequential.
•
Numbered lists indicate a set of sequential steps, i.e., those that describe step-bystep procedures.
•
“Tap” refers to selecting an option on the display using the stylus.
Related Documents
•
CRD 1700-4000S Cradle Quick Reference Guide, p/n 60308-001
•
CRD 1800-1000S Cradle Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-54489-xx
•
CRD 1700-1000M-1 Modem Cradle Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-55040-xx
•
CRD 1700-4000E Ethernet Cradle Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-39472-xx
•
CHX700-4000C Charging Cradle Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-50367-xx
•
MDM 3006 Modem Module Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-55338-xx
•
MSR 3000 Magnetic Stripe Reader Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-38392-xx
•
VCA 3000 Charging Adaptor Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-51938-xx
•
Keypad Module Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-54733-xx
•
S24 Site Survey Utility User Guide, p/n 72E-39283-xx
•
Spectrum24 Access Point AP-3020 Product Reference Guide, p/n 70-20504-xx
•
SPT 1700 Series Site Admin Tool User Guide, p/n 72E-39284-xx
•
SPT 1733/2733 CDPD Developer’s Guide, p/n 72E-42911-xx
•
SPT 173X/183X WAN Developer’s Guide, p/n 72E-56804-xx
•
SPT 1740 Spectrum24 Driver Extensions Library Developer’s Guide,
p/n 70-38524-xx
•
SPT 1740 Web Client User’s Guide, p/n 72-42792-xx
•
SPT 1800 Series Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-51336-xx
•
SPT Terminal Series System Software Manual, p/n 72E-56803-xx
•
VCD 1700 Installation Instructions (Vehicle Cradle), p/n 72-43825-xx
•
VCD 1700 Series Vehicle Cradle Quick Reference Guide, p/n 72-42033-xx
xiv
About This Guide
Service Information
If you have a problem with your equipment, contact the Symbol Support Center for your
region. See page xv for contact information. Before calling, have the model number, serial
number, and several of your bar code symbols at hand.
Call the Support Center from a phone near the scanning equipment so that the service
person can try to talk you through your problem. If the equipment is found to be working
properly and the problem is symbol readability, the Support Center will request samples of
your bar codes for analysis at our plant.
If your problem cannot be solved over the phone, you may need to return your equipment
for servicing. If that is necessary, you will be given specific directions.
Note: Symbol Technologies is not responsible for any damages incurred
during shipment if the approved shipping container is not used.
Shipping the units improperly can possibly void the warranty. If the
original shipping container was not kept, contact Symbol to have
another sent to you.
Symbol Support Center
For service information, warranty information or technical assistance contact or call the
Symbol Support Center in:
United States 1
Symbol Technologies, Inc.
One Symbol Plaza
Holtsville, New York 11742-1300
1-800-653-5350
Canada
Symbol Technologies Canada, Inc.
2540 Matheson Boulevard East
Mississauga, Ontario, Canada L4W 4Z2
905-629-7226
xv
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
United Kingdom
Symbol Technologies
Symbol Place
Winnersh Triangle, Berkshire RG41 5TP
United Kingdom
0800 328 2424 (Inside UK)
+44 118 945 7529 (Outside UK)
Asia/Pacific
Symbol Technologies Asia, Inc (Singapore
Branch)
230 Victoria Street #05-07/09
Bugis Junction Office Tower
Singapore 188024
Tel : +65-6796-9600
Fax : +65-6337-6488
Australia
Symbol Technologies Pty. Ltd.
432 St. Kilda Road
Melbourne, Victoria 3004
1-800-672-906 (Inside Australia)
+61-3-9866-6044 (Outside Australia)
Austria/Österreich
Symbol Technologies Austria GmbH
Prinz-Eugen Strasse 70 / 2.Haus
1040 Vienna, Austria
01-5055794-0 (Inside Austria)
+43-1-5055794-0 (Outside Austria)
Denmark/Danmark
Symbol Technologies AS
Dr. Neergaardsvej 3
2970 Hørsholm
7020-1718 (Inside Denmark)
+45-7020-1718 (Outside Denmark)
Europe/Mid-East Distributor Operations
Contact your local distributor or call
+44 118 945 7360
Finland/Suomi
Oy Symbol Technologies
Kaupintie 8 A 6
FIN-00440 Helsinki, Finland
9 5407 580 (Inside Finland)
+358 9 5407 580 (Outside Finland)
France
Symbol Technologies France
Centre d'Affaire d'Antony
3 Rue de la Renaissance
92184 Antony Cedex, France
01-40-96-52-21 (Inside France)
+33-1-40-96-52-50 (Outside France)
xvi
About This Guide
Germany/Deutchland
Symbol Technologies GmbH
Waldstrasse 66
D-63128 Dietzenbach, Germany
6074-49020 (Inside Germany)
+49-6074-49020 (Outside Germany)
Italy/Italia
Symbol Technologies Italia S.R.L.
Via Cristoforo Columbo, 49
20090 Trezzano S/N Navigilo
Milano, Italy
2-484441 (Inside Italy)
+39-02-484441 (Outside Italy)
Latin America Sales Support
2730 University Dr.
Coral Springs, FL 33065 USA
1-800-347-0178 (Inside United States)
+1-954-255-2610 (Outside United States)
954-340-9454 (Fax)
Mexico/México
Symbol Technologies Mexico Ltd.
Torre Picasso
Boulevard Manuel Avila Camacho No 88
Lomas de Chapultepec CP 11000
Mexico City, DF, Mexico
5-520-1835 (Inside Mexico)
+52-5-520-1835 (Outside Mexico)
Netherlands/Nederland
Symbol Technologies
Kerkplein 2, 7051 CX
Postbus 24 7050 AA
Varsseveld, Netherlands
315-271700 (Inside Netherlands)
+31-315-271700 (Outside Netherlands)
Norway/Norge
Symbol’s registered and mailing address:
Symbol Technologies Norway
Hoybratenveien 35 C
N-1055 OSLO, Norway
Symbol’s repair depot and shipping address:
Symbol Technologies Norway
Enebakkveien 123
N-0680 OSLO, Norway
+47 2232 4375
South Africa
Symbol Technologies Africa Inc.
Block B2
Rutherford Estate
1 Scott Street
Waverly 2090 Johannesburg
Republic of South Africa
11-809 5311 (Inside South Africa)
+27-11-809 5311 (Outside South Africa)
Spain/España
Symbol Technologies S.L.
Avenida de Bruselas, 22
Edificio Sauce
Alcobendas, Madrid 28108
Spain
91 324 40 00 (Inside Spain)
+34 91 324 40 00 (Outside Spain)
Fax: +34.91.324.4010
xvii
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Sweden/Sverige
“Letter” address:
Symbol Technologies AB
Box 1354
S-171 26 SOLNA
Sweden
Visit/shipping address:
Symbol Technologies AB
Solna Strandväg 78
S-171 54 SOLNA
Sweden
Switchboard: 08 445 29 00 (domestic)
Call Center: +46 8 445 29 29 (international)
Support E-Mail:
[email protected]
1Customer
support is available 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.
If you purchased your Symbol product from a Symbol Business Partner, contact that
Business Partner for service.
For the latest version of this guide go to:http://www.symbol.com/manuals.
xviii
Chapter 1
Getting Started
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Unpacking the Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Parts of the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Getting Started. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Installing the Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Charging the Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
Starting the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
Configuring the Spectrum24 Network (SPT 184x only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
Configuring the Wide Area Network (SPT 1833 only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
Using the SPT 1800. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Using the Power Button/Backlight Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Using the Contrast Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Writing with the Stylus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Tapping Versus Clicking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
Using the Onscreen Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
Icon Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
Cables and Cradles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
Synchronization/Charging Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
CRD1800-1000S Single-slot Serial Cradle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
CRD1700-4000S Four-slot Serial Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18
CRD1700-1000M-1 Modem Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19
CRD1700-4000E Four-slot Ethernet Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20
Four-slot Charging Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21
VCD 1700/VCD X800Vehicle Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
VCA 3000 Vehicle Charging Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
1-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
MSR 3000 Mag Stripe Reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
Using the MSR 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
Charging the Terminal’s Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
TRG 3000 Trigger Handle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
Replacing the Handstrap. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
System Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-31
1-2
Getting Started
Introduction
This chapter explains the physical buttons and controls on your SPT 1800 terminal, how to
install and charge the battery, start your SPT 1800 terminal for the first time, set up your
cradle and install your Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software.
Unpacking the Terminal
Carefully remove all protective material from around the terminal and save the shipping
packaging for later storage and shipping.
Verify that you received all equipment listed on the packing slip and inspect the equipment
for damage. If any equipment is missing or damaged, contact the Symbol Technologies
Support Center immediately. Refer to page xv for contact information.
Accessories
The following are accessories for the SPT 1800:
•
Single-slot Modem Cradle
•
Single-slot Serial Cradle
•
Four-slot Charging Cradle
•
Four-slot Ethernet Cradle
•
Four-slot Serial Cradle
•
Vehicle Cradle
•
Snap-On Modem Module
•
Snap-On DEX Cable
•
Snap-On Keypad
•
Mag Stripe Reader
•
TRG 3000 Trigger Handle
•
Synchronization/Charging Cable
•
Vehicle Charging Adapter
•
Holster
•
Lanyard
•
Spare Battery.
1-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Parts of the SPT 1800
Front View
WAN Antenna
(SPT 1833 only)
Laser Decode LED
Center Scan Button
Scroll Button
(Up and Down)
Scroll Button
(Up and Down)
Right Scan Trigger
LCD (Screen)
Input Area
Calculator Icon
Applications Icon
Find Icon
Menu Icon
Contrast Button
Power Button
Application Buttons
Left View
Left Scan Trigger
1-4
Getting Started
Back View
Stylus
Stylus Silo
Infrared Port
Handstrap
Connector
Speaker
Reset Button
Battery
Compartment
Lithium-Ion Battery
Battery Latches
Battery Cover
Handstrap Connectors
Top View
Scanner Exit Window
Bottom View
Serial Port
1-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Getting Started
Before you can use your SPT 1800, perform the basic set up procedures covered on the
following pages. Specifically:
•
Install and charge the battery
•
Start the SPT 1800
•
Initiate a Spectrum24 network (SPT 184x only) or wide area network (WAN)
connection (SPT 1833 only).
Installing the Battery
To install the battery in your SPT 1800:
1. Open the latches on the battery cover and lift it away from the SPT 1800.
Latch
Latch
1-6
Getting Started
2. Insert the lithium-ion battery in the battery compartment, making sure it snaps into
place.
3. Replace the battery cover and re-secure the latches.
Note: Be careful to position the battery latches completely open while
securing the battery cover on the terminal.
Charging the Battery
Caution
The main battery charges the backup battery in the SPT 1800. Once the
battery is fully charged, do not remove it from the SPT 1800 for 24 hours.
During this period, the SPT 1800 cannot maintain any user data if the battery is removed from the terminal.
Before using your SPT 1800 for the first time, charge the lithium-ion battery. The terminal’s
battery can be charged using a charging cradle, the Synchronization/Charging Cable, or
the Universal Battery Charger (UBC). For instructions on using the UBC to charge your
batteries, refer to the Quick Reference Guide which came with your UBC. Follow these
same procedures to recharge the battery when the terminal’s battery level is low.
Using a Cradle to Charge the Battery
To charge the terminal’s battery using a cradle:
1. Ensure the battery is installed in the terminal. Refer to Installing the Battery on
page 1-6 for instructions.
1-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
2. Ensure the cradle is plugged into a wall outlet. Refer to Cables and Cradles on
page 1-15.
3. Insert the SPT 1800 terminal in the cradle as shown:
Battery
Charging
LED
On the CRD 1800-1000S serial cradle and the CRD 1700-1000M-1 modem cradle,
the battery charging LED turns red to indicate that the battery is charging, then
turns green after approximately two hours to indicate that the terminal’s battery is
fully charged.
Note: On older CRD 1700 single slot and modem cradles, the charging
LED may not illuminate green when the terminal’s battery is fully
charged.
Spare Battery Charging
The CRD1800-1000S single-slot cradle has a spare battery charging slot which charges
the terminal’s spare battery. Insert the battery in the spare battery charging slot in the back
of the cradle. The spare battery charging LED turns red to indicate the spare battery is
1-8
Getting Started
charging, then turns green after approximately two hours to indicate the battery is fully
charged.
Spare Battery
Spare Battery
Charging LED
Starting the SPT 1800
After installing and charging the battery, start the terminal by pressing the red power button
on the front of the SPT 1800. If the terminal does not power on, perform a hard reset (refer
to Performing a Hard Reset on page 18-5).
Note: When starting the terminal for the first time, or whenever the battery
is completely drained, a hard reset is required.
The first time you start the SPT 1800, Welcome setup instructions appear onscreen. These
instructions include screen calibration and time and date setting. Calibration aligns the
internal circuitry of the SPT 1800 with its touch-sensitive screen so your SPT 1800 can
detect the task you want to perform when you tap an element on the screen.
1. Remove the stylus from the back of the terminal.
1-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
2. Use the stylus to tap anywhere on the screen.
3. Tap anywhere on the next screen.
4. Follow the on-screen instructions, tapping the screen where indicated. Tap the
exact center of each target that displays on the screen with the tip of the stylus.
5. The third screen allows you to set the country, time zone, date and time.
6. Select a country from the Country pick list.
7. Tap the Time Zone box. The Set Time Zone screen appears.
1-10
Getting Started
8. Use the up and down arrows to scroll to your country and time zone. The terminal’s
scroll buttons can be used to scroll the list a page at a time.
9. Make sure your time zone is highlighted, then tap OK.
Tip: Choose the time zone from the list that corresponds to where you are. When
you travel, use this dialog to change time zones. If you’re not sure what time zone
you are in, find out what time it is, and select the time zone which shows the current
new time. Do not use the time zone dialog to switch between daylight savings time
and standard time. Use the Daylight Savings pick list.
10. Tap on the Daylight Saving pick list to toggle this feature on or off.
11. Tap the Set Date box.
12. Tap the arrows at the top of the screen to select the current year. Tap the month;
then tap the current date.
Tap arrows to select year
Tap to select month
Tap to select date
13. The screen closes and the dates you selected are displayed in the Set Date box.
14. Tap the Time box.
1-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
15. Tap each minute number, and then tap an arrow to change the number.
16. If applicable, tap AM or PM.
17. Tap OK to set the new time and return to the previous screen.
Note: To display time based on a 24-hour clock, change the time format.
See Time, Date, Week Start and Numbers Formats on page 13-10.
18. Tap the Next button to read instructions on entering text or tap the Done button to
finish.
Configuring the Spectrum24 Network (SPT 184x only)
Before the SPT 184x can be used on the Spectrum24 wireless LAN, your facility must be
set up with the equipment required to run the wireless LAN and your terminal must be
properly configured. Refer to Chapter 2, Network Setup for instructions on configuring your
terminal for use with Spectrum24.
Configuring the Wide Area Network (SPT 1833 only)
Before the SPT 1833 can be used on a WAN (CDPD), your terminal must be properly
configured. Refer to Chapter 2, Network Setup for instructions on configuring your terminal
for use with WAN.
1-12
Getting Started
Using the SPT 1800
This section describes the procedures for the basic use of the SPT 1800 series terminal.
Topics covered include powering on the terminal, using the backlight, adjusting the screen
contrast, writing with the stylus and using the onscreen keyboard.
Using the Power Button/Backlight Control
The power button turns the SPT 1800 on and off. This button also serves as your backlight
control for low-light conditions. With the unit on, press and hold the power button for
approximately 2 seconds to turn the backlight on and off.
Using the Contrast Control
To adjust the contrast:
Contrast
Control
1. Press the contrast control button, which displays the contrast adjusting bar on the
terminal’s screen.
2. Using your stylus, adjust the contrast by scrolling the contrast bar until the contrast
is set to the desired level, or use either of the scroll buttons on the top of the
terminal to adjust the contrast level.
3. Press the contrast control button or tap Done on the screen to turn off the contrast
control.
Writing with the Stylus
Your SPT 1800 includes Graffiti 2 handwriting software as the primary system for entering
text and numbers. Graffiti 2 is a system where simple strokes you write with the stylus are
1-13
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
instantly recognized as letters or numbers. Refer to Writing Graffiti 2 with the Stylus on
page 3-6 for more information.
Tapping Versus Clicking
Just as you use a mouse pointer to click elements on your computer’s screen, you use the
stylus to tap elements on your SPT 1800’s touch-sensitive screen. Tapping is the basic
action used to execute tasks on your SPT 1800.
Note: Always use the point of the stylus for tapping or making strokes on
the SPT 1800 screen. Do not use a pen, pencil, or any other sharp
object to write on the SPT 1800 screen. If you misplace your stylus,
visit the www.symbol.com site for information on a replacement.
With your SPT 1800 turned on, you can tap the screen to perform many operations, such
as the following:
•
Open applications.
•
Choose menu commands.
•
Initiate a global Find operation.
•
Select options in dialog boxes.
•
Open the onscreen keyboards.
Just as you drag the mouse to select text or move objects on your computer, you can drag
the stylus to select text. In addition, you can use the stylus to drag the slider of any scroll
bar.
Using the Onscreen Keyboard
You can activate the on-screen keyboard any time you need to enter text or numbers on
your SPT 1800. Note that you can enter Graffiti 2 characters while using the on-screen
keyboard.
To use the on-screen keyboard:
1. Open any SPT 1800 application.
2. Tap any record name, or tap the New button with the tip of the stylus.
1-14
Getting Started
3. Tap the left target to open the Alpha keyboard, or tap the right target to open the
Numeric keyboard.
Tap here for letters
keyboard
Tap here for numbers
keyboard
Refer to Using the On-Screen Keyboard on page 3-15 for additional information.
Icon Descriptions
Applications
Icon
Tap to exit the current application and to display a list of available
applications for selection.
Calculator
Icon
Tap to display the calculator application.
Menu Icon
Tap from within an application to display the menu of options for the
selected application.
Find Icon
Tap from within an application to enter search criteria to find an entry.
Cables and Cradles
There are optional cable and cradle solutions that enable you to charge the terminal’s
battery and synchronize information on your SPT 1800 terminal with host system
applications:
•
Synchronization/Charging Cable
•
CRD1800-1000S Single-slot Serial Cradle
•
CRD1700-4000S Four-slot Serial Cradle
•
CRD1700-1000M-1 Single-slot Modem Cradle
•
CRD1700-4000E Four-slot Ethernet Cradle
•
CHS X700-4000C Four-slot Charging Cradle
•
VCD 1700/VCD X800 Vehicle Cradle
1-15
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
•
CBL-1700 Snap-On DEX Cable
•
VCA 3000 Vehicle Charging Adapter.
Synchronization/Charging Cable
To connect the Synchronization/Charging Cable:
1. Make sure the battery is installed in the terminal. Refer to Installing the Battery on
page 1-6 for instructions.
2. Turn off your host computer.
3. Plug the serial cable into the serial communication port on your host computer.
Note: You may require a 9-pin to 25-pin adapter, p/n 160-0072 to connect
the cable to the serial port on the back of your host computer.
Note: Your SPT 1800 terminal requires a dedicated port. It cannot share a
port with an internal modem or other device. If you are unsure about
the location of the serial port on your computer, refer to the user’s
manual supplied with the computer.
4. Insert the cable into the bottom of the terminal, as shown.
Synchronization/
Charging Cable
1-16
Getting Started
5. Plug the power cable into a wall outlet and plug the other end into the battery
charging receptacle on the side of the Synchronization/Charging Cable.
Battery Charging
Receptacle
Power Supply
Serial Cable to Host
Computer
CRD1800-1000S Single-slot Serial Cradle
To connect the cradle:
1. Turn off your computer.
2. Plug one end of the serial cable into the host connector on the back of the cradle.
3. Plug the other end of the serial cable into the serial communication port on your
computer.
Note: You may require a 9-pin to 25-pin adapter, p/n 160-0072 to connect
the cable to the serial port on the back of your computer.
1-17
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: Your SPT 1800 terminal requires a dedicated port. It cannot share a
port with an internal modem or other device. If you are unsure about
the location of the serial port on your computer, refer to the user’s
manual supplied with the computer.
4. Connect the power jack to the power receptacle on the back of the cradle.
5. Plug the power cable into the wall.
CRD1700-4000S Four-slot Serial Cradle
To connect the cradle:
1. Turn off your computer.
2. Plug one end of the serial cable into the host connector on the back of the cradle.
3. Plug the other end of the serial cable into the serial communication port on your
computer.
Note: You may require a 9-pin to 25-pin adapter, p/n 160-0072 to connect
the cable to the serial port on the back of your computer.
1-18
Getting Started
Note: Your SPT 1800 terminal requires a dedicated port. It cannot share a
port with an internal modem or other device. If you are unsure about
the location of the serial port on your computer, refer to the user’s
manual supplied with the computer.
4. Connect the power jack into the power receptacle on the back of the cradle.
5. Plug the power cable into the wall.
CRD1700-1000M-1 Modem Cradle
To connect the cradle:
1. Turn off your computer.
2. Plug the RJ-41 connector of the communication cable into the Line Out port on the
back of the cradle.
3. Plug the other end of the cable into the serial port on the back of your computer.
4. Plug one end of the phone cord into the Line In port on the cradle, and the other
end into a wall phone jack.
5. Connect one end of the power cable into the power port on the back of the cradle,
and plug the other end into a wall outlet.
Note: Your SPT 1800 terminal requires a dedicated port. It cannot share a
port with an internal modem or other device. If you are unsure about
the location of the serial port on your computer, refer to the user’s
manual supplied with the computer.
1-19
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Refer to Chapter 10, Applications: HotSync® for instructions on configuring the cradle and
terminal for modem synchronization.
CRD1700-4000E Four-slot Ethernet Cradle
Before setting up the cradle, make sure that Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software is
installed and running on the host computer, as well as properly configured Network
HotSync software on the SPT 1800 terminal. Refer to Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
Software on page 1-29 for instructions on installing this software. Specific software setup
necessary to use the CRD1700-4000E is discussed in Chapter 10, Applications:
HotSync®.
A DHCP server must be configured and operational on the subnet to which the cradle will
be attached.
To connect the cradle:
1. Connect the power supply cable round plug to the power connector on the back of
the cradle.
2. Connect the power supply AC plug to a standard electrical outlet.
Note: International customers must use a separate AC power cable
appropriate for their respective country.
DC Power
Connector
The cradle’s LEDs blink, then remain off until a terminal is inserted into one or more of the
slots.
1-20
Getting Started
To set up for network communications:
1. Ensure there is a DHCP server accessible to the CRD1700-4000E on the subnet
to which it will be attached.
2. Connect one end of a standard 10 Base-T network cable to the middle connector
on the back of the CRD1700-4000E. Connect the other end of the cable to a hub
which is connected to your subnet.
3. Power-up the unit; the CRD1700-4000E performs its power-up sequence, then
attempts to collect all network parameters from the local DHCP server.
If configuration of the unit from the local DHCP server fails, all LEDs flash red. The unit
becomes unresponsive until power is removed, the unit is connected to a network with a
DHCP server, and power is restored.
Note: Before communication between the SPT 1800 terminal and the host
computer can take place, the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
Software must be installed and running on the host computer.
Four-slot Charging Cradle
To connect the cradle:
1. Connect the power supply cable round plug to the power connector on the back of
the cradle.
2. Connect the power supply AC plug to a standard electrical outlet.
1-21
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: International customers must use a separate AC power cable
appropriate for their respective country.
DC Power
Connector
The cradle’s LEDs blink, then remain off until a terminal is inserted into one or more of the
slots.
VCD 1700/VCD X800Vehicle Cradle
The SPT 1800 provides a serial port at the bottom of the terminal. When you insert a
terminal into a vehicle cradle, it connects to the cradle’s serial port. The terminal can then
use the cradle’s serial port to communicate with an external device. Refer to Quick
Reference Guide for your vehicle cradle for instructions on installing the cradle in a vehicle.
To connect the cradle:
1. Plug a 9-pin serial cable into the serial port located next to the power port at the
bottom of the cradle. Note that some devices may require the serial cable to be a
null modem cable.
Note: The external device must use an RS-232 serial connection limited to
TXD, RXD, RTS and CTS data lines. It must also have its own power
supply, as the cradle’s serial port does not provide power.
2. Connect the other end of the cable to the serial port of the external device (e.g., a
host computer, printer, or modem).
1-22
Getting Started
Power
input cable
To vehicle
power source
Serial cable
To external
device
To begin communication:
1. Insert the terminal into the cradle.
2. Connect the Power Input cable to your vehicle power source. Then plug the cable
into the Power Port on the terminal.
3. To initiate communication, make appropriate selections on the terminal, as
determined by the application you are using.
Note: Removing a terminal during data communication will disrupt
communication between the terminal and the attached device.
1-23
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
VCA 3000 Vehicle Charging Adapter
The VCA-3000 Vehicle Charging Adapter connects to the cigarette lighter in your vehicle to
charge the battery. To set up the VCA 3000:
1. Insert the connector into the cigarette lighter of your vehicle.
2. Insert the terminal into the module at the other end of the VCA 3000.
Terminal Release
Buttons
The terminal’s battery begins charging automatically.
3. To remove the terminal from the VCA 3000, press both terminal release buttons
and pull the terminal up.
1-24
Getting Started
MSR 3000 Mag Stripe Reader
The MSR 3000 Magnetic Stripe Reader allows easy data capture with the swipe of a
magnetic stripe card. To install the MSR 3000:
1. Place the MSR 3000 on the bottom of the terminal as shown, ensuring it snaps into
place.
2. To remove, simultaneously press the release buttons on both sides of the magnetic
stripe reader and pull the terminal up.
Left Release
Button
Right Release
Button
1-25
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Using the MSR 3000
In order to use the MSR 3000, your SPT 1800 must have an application installed which
accepts magnetic stripe data. The MSR 3000 System Software Manual (p/n 72-38411-xx)
describes the application programming interface which can be used to develop MSR
applications on the SPT 1800.
To use the Magnetic Stripe Reader:
1. Tap the
icon.
2. Tap the icon associated with the Magnetic Stripe Reader application on your
terminal.
3. Swipe the magnetic stripe card through the reader, ensuring the magnetic stripe on
the card is positioned as shown in the following illustration.
Note: The card may be swiped in either direction, from left to right, or from
right to left. For best results, gently press down on the card while
swiping to ensure contact with the bottom of the reader.
Charging the Terminal’s Battery
The terminal’s battery can be charged while the MSR 3000 is in place on the bottom of the
terminal, using the Power Supply (p/n 50-14000-107) and Line Cord (p/n 50-16000-182).
Note: To use the cradles for charging and batch communication, you must
first remove the Magnetic Stripe Reader from the bottom of the
terminal.
1-26
Getting Started
To charge the terminal’s battery using the power supply and line cord:
1. Insert the adapter cable into the power port on the bottom of the MSR as shown.
2. Plug the wall plug into the wall outlet. The terminal’s battery is fully charged after
two hours.
The terminal can be used while plugged into the wall outlet.
TRG 3000 Trigger Handle
The TRG 3000 Trigger Handle adds a trigger in scanning gun form to your terminal,
increasing comfort when using the terminal in scan-intensive applications for extended
periods of time.
Note: The SPT 1800 Series terminal does not require additional file
downloads. The software for this accessory reside in the operating
system.
Whether you perform a hard or soft reset on the terminal, the file will
not be lost.
1-27
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To install the trigger handle hardware:
1. Slide the terminal into the Trigger Handle until it locks in place.
Note: For some terminal models, you must remove the filler block from the
front of the handle.
Filler Block
Release
Spring
To remove the terminal, press down the release spring and pull the terminal forward.
Note: Remove the Trigger Handle when synchronizing with the desktop
computer. Wireless synchronization can be performed while the
handle is attached.
To scan bar codes using the Trigger Handle:
1. Start the terminal’s scanning application.
2. Aim the terminal at the bar code.
3. Pull the trigger on the handle. Make sure the red scan beam covers the entire bar
code. The green scan LED lights and a beep sounds to indicate a successful
decode.
1-28
Getting Started
Replacing the Handstrap
The terminal has a factory-installed handstrap which increases comfort when holding the
terminal for extended periods of time. The handstrap may be removed or replaced, if
damaged.
To replace the handstrap on the SPT 1800, 184x and 1833 terminals:
1. Unhook the bottom of the handstrap from the handstrap connector on the battery
cover.
2. Remove the metal piece, threaded through the metal handstrap connector on the
back of the terminal.
Metal handstrap
connector
Metal piece
Handstrap
connector
3. Thread the metal piece of the new handstrap through the metal handstrap
connector on the back of the terminal.
4. Slide the flat metal piece into the handstrap connector on the battery cover.
5. Adjust the velcro® strap to fit your hand.
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software extends many of the functions of your SPT 1800
Series terminal to your computer. Although using Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software
1-29
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
is optional, when you use it with your SPT 1800 Series terminal and the built-in HotSync
technology, you can fully synchronize the information on your SPT 1800 Series terminal
with the information on your computer. Changes you make on your SPT 1800 Series
terminal or Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop display in both places after you synchronize.
With Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software you can:
•
Work with your SPT 1800 terminal applications on your computer. The Symbol
Palm Terminal Desktop software duplicates the Date Book, Address Book, To Do
List and Memo Pad applications on your SPT 1800 terminal, so you can view, enter
and modify any data stored on your SPT 1800 terminal.
•
Back up the data stored on your SPT 1800 terminal with HotSync technology and
synchronize the data with the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software.
Synchronization is a one-step procedure that ensures your data is always safe and
up-to-date. Refer to Chapter 10, Applications: HotSync® for information about
using this feature.
•
Import and export data, so you can easily transfer data from other Windows
applications into Address Book or Memo Pad.
•
Print your Date Book, Address Book, To Do List and Memo Pad information on any
Windows-compatible printer.
System Requirements
To install and operate the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software, your computer system
must meet the following requirements:
•
Windows 95 or higher
•
IBM-compatible 486 computer or higher
•
8 MB RAM (memory) minimum, 16 MB recommended
•
12 MB available hard disk space
•
VGA monitor or better
•
CD-ROM drive
•
Mouse
•
One available serial port.
Optional Equipment
•
Modem
•
Windows-compatible printer.
1-30
Getting Started
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software Installation
Go to http://devzone.symbol.com to download the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
software.
The following instructions guide you through installing the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
software. After you install the software, refer to the Help menu for complete information
about how to use the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software.
To ensure a safe and uninterrupted installation of the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
software, do the following before installing:
•
Connect the cradle to your computer.
•
If you have placed your SPT 1800 terminal in the cradle, remove it during software
installation.
•
Exit all programs, including those that run automatically at startup, such as fax
software, virus protection software, screen-saver software and application toolbars
such as Microsoft® Office.
•
Do not simply copy the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop files to your hard drive. You
must use the installer to place the files in their proper locations and then
decompress them.
1-31
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
1-32
Chapter 2
Network Setup
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Data Encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
WEP Encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Kerberos Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Configuring a Spectrum24 Connection
(SPT 184x Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
SPT 1842 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
SPT 1846 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Configuring a CDPD WAN Connection
(SPT 1833 Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Setup Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
Maintenance Screens and Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
Merlin Menu Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
2-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
2-2
Network Setup
Introduction
Wireless networks allow SPT 1800 Series terminals to communicate wirelessly, and to
send captured data “real time” to a host device. Terminals and their supported network
types are:
Terminal
Network Technology
SPT 184x
Spectrum24 (LAN)
SPT 1833
CDPD (WAN)
Before a terminal can be used on a Spectrum24 LAN, your facility must be set up with the
equipment required to run the network and the terminal must be properly configured. Before
a terminal can be used on a CDPD WAN, you must activate your device on the network.
Refer to the following sections for specific configuration information for each terminal type:
Configuring a Spectrum24 Connection (SPT 184x Only) on page 2-5 and Configuring a
CDPD WAN Connection (SPT 1833 Only) on page 2-11.
Data Encryption
Note: Data Encryption is only available on SPT 1846 terminal.
Security is becoming more of a concern in today’s wireless environment and the possibility
exists that someone could obtain unauthorized access to your network. The user must
determine whether enhanced data encryption is necessary for their application.
Encryption becomes the most efficient method in preventing unauthorized network access
and improving data security. Encryption entails scrambling and coding information, typically
with mathematical formulas called algorithms, before the information is transmitted. An
algorithm is a set of instructions or formula for scrambling the data. A key is the specific
code used by the algorithm to encrypt or decrypt the data. Decryption is the decoding and
unscrambling of received encrypted data.
The same device, host computer or front-end processor, usually performs both encryption
and decryption. The data transmit or receive direction determines whether the encryption
or decryption function is performed. The device takes plain text, encrypts or scrambles the
text typically by mathematically combining the key with the plain text as instructed by the
algorithm, then transmits the data over the network. At the receiving end, another device
2-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
takes the encrypted text and decrypts, or unscrambles, the text revealing the original
message. An unauthorized user can know the algorithm, but cannot interpret the encrypted
data without the appropriate key. Only the sender and receiver of the transmitted data know
the key.
WEP Encryption
Symbol uses the Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) algorithm, specified in IEEE 802.11
section 8, for encryption and decryption. WEP uses the same key for both encrypting and
decrypting text. Typically an external key service distributes the key. Users should change
the key often for added security. IEEE 802.11 defines two types of authentication, Open
System and Shared Key. Open system authentication is a null authentication algorithm.
Shared key authentication is an algorithm where both the Access Point and the terminal
share an authentication key to perform a checksum on the original message. Both 40-bit
and 128-bit shared key encryption algorithms are supported in the Symbol Spectrum24
environment. Terminals are required to use the same encryption algorithm to interoperate.
Access Points and terminals cannot transmit and receive if the Access Point is using 128bit encryption and the terminal is using a 40-bit encryption algorithm.
By default, IEEE 802.11 devices operate in an open system network where any wireless
device can associate with an Access Point without authorization. The SPT 1846 terminal
with a valid shared key is allowed to associate with the Access Point. Authentication
management messages (packets) are unicast, meaning authentication messages transmit
from one Access Point to one terminal only, not broadcast or multicast.
Kerberos Authentication
Authentication is critical for the security of any wireless LAN device, including a Spectrum24
device operating on a wireless network. Traditional authentication methods are not suitable
for use in wireless networks where an unauthorized user can monitor network traffic and
intercept passwords. The use of strong authentication methods that do not disclose
passwords is necessary. Symbol uses the Kerberos authentication service protocol
(specified in RFC 1510), to authenticate users/clients in a wireless network environment
and to securely distribute the encryption keys used for both encrypting and decrypting plain
text.
2-4
Network Setup
Configuring a Spectrum24 Connection
(SPT 184x Only)
SPT 1842 Configuration
To configure your SPT 1842 terminal for use on a Spectrum24 network:
1. On the Main Application screen, tap the
icon.
2. Tap the preference options pick list and select Network. The Network Preference
screen displays:
Note: Refer to Network Preferences Menu Commands on page 13-27 for
details about using the Network Preferences menu options.
3. Tap the Service pick list and select Spectrum24, then tap Details. The Spectrum24
Preferences screen displays:
2-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Enter the following information:
Extended Service Set The ESSID identifies the radio network and differentiates
ID (ESSID).
between different radio networks. All terminals on the same
network, as well as the access points in your facility, must have
the same ESSID. Ask your System Administrator for the correct
ESSID number of your network.
Show on Assoc.
Screen
Displays the ESSID name that the terminal is trying to associate
with in the Service Connection Process screen.
Internet Protocol (IP)
address.
Each SPT 184x terminal requires a unique internet address (IP
address). This address can be administered and entered
manually through the terminal, or administered and allocated by
a server on the network, using DHCP.
DNS
The IP address of a server containing a database of host names
and their associated IP addresses so that when a host name is
used, it can be resolved into its IP address.
Note: The default value for this field is Use DHCP. Use this option if you
want the IP address to be dynamically selected by the DHCP server.
4. To manually enter the IP address information for this terminal, deselect Use DHCP
and tap Settings. The IP Settings screen displays:
5. Enter the IP address, Subnet mask, and Gateway address for this terminal.
Tap each field to display a keypad for selection of the address information. Each
part of the four-part address must be in the range of 0-255; numbers are the only
allowable characters in these fields. Ask your Internet Service Provider or your
System Administrator for the correct IP, Subnet and Gateway information.
6. Tap Done to exit the Keypad.
7. Tap OK to save the information and return to the Spectrum24 Preferences screen.
2-6
Network Setup
8. To enable DNS, tap the Enable DNS box. A Details button is added to the
screen.
Note: Many systems do not require a DNS. If you are not sure, leave the
DNS fields blank.
a. Tap the Details button to display the Details screen.
Enter the Host and Domain Names. If you need more space to enter name
information, tap the arrow to the right of these fields to display a blank screen.
Tap the Primary and Secondary DNS fields to display a keypad to enter the
address information for these fields. Each part of the four-part address must be
in the range of 0-255; numbers are the only allowable characters in these
fields. Ask your Internet Service Provider or System Administrator for the
correct Primary or Secondary DNS numbers.
b. Tap OK to save the information and return to the Spectrum24 Preferences
Screen, or Cancel to return to this screen without saving the DNS information.
SPT 1846 Configuration
To configure your SPT 1846 terminal for use on a Spectrum24 network:
1. On the Main Application screen, tap the
icon.
2. Tap the preference options pick list and select Network. The Network Preference
screen displays:
2-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: Refer to Network Preferences Menu Commands on page 13-27 for
details about using the Network Preferences menu options.
3. Tap the Service pick list and select Spectrum24, then tap Details. The Spectrum24
Preferences screen displays:
Enter the following information:
Extended Service Set The ESSID identifies the radio network and differentiates
ID (ESSID).
between different radio networks. All terminals on the same
network, as well as the access points in your facility, must have
the same ESSID. Ask your System Administrator for the correct
ESSID number of your network.
Show on Assoc.
Screen
Displays the ESSID name that the terminal is trying to associate
with in the Service Connection Process screen.
Internet Protocol (IP)
address.
Each SPT 184x terminal requires a unique internet address (IP
address). This address can be administered and entered
manually through the terminal, or administered and allocated by
a server on the network, using DHCP.
DNS
The IP address of a server containing a database of host names
and their associated IP addresses so that when a host name is
used, it can be resolved into its IP address.
4. Tap the Radio Config button to set the radio configuration parameters.
5. Enter your Radio Config password then tap OK.
Note: For first time users, the default password is Symbol.
2-8
Network Setup
6. The Radio Configuration screen appears.
PwrMode
The power-saving level of the terminal. Power Mode 5 uses the least
power and is the recommended configuration.
Diversity
Determines whether the radio firmware attempts to use one or two
antenna ports for communications. It is important to match this setting
with the actual number of antennas in use.
If set to “Both”, the radio firmware attempts to use both antenna ports
for communications.
Both is the default and provides the best chance of a clear signal.
Preamble
Approximately 8 bytes of the packet header generated by the Access
Point and is attached to the packet prior to transmission. Preamble
length is transmission data rate dependent. The Short preamble is
50% shorter than Long preamble.
Both the SPT 1846 and Access Point need to be set to the same
preamble to associate.
Intl Roaming Enables the adapter to roam and associate to Access Points with
country codes other than the United States.
Password
Displays the current password. To change the password, tap the Edit
button.
Encryption
Tap to select encryption type (Open System, 40-bit Shared Key, 128bit Shared Key or Kerberos), an efficient method of preventing data
theft and improving data security.
40-bit encryption: Requires a 10 Hex digit Encryption key.
128-bit encryption: Requires a 26 Hex digit Encryption key.
Key Index
Specifies which key (Key1 - Key 4) to use when transmitting to an
access point.
Key1 - Key4
Specific key codes required for encryption.
2-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
7. For Open System Configuration:
Open System does not use any type of encryption algorithm. To configure Open
System:
a. Select Open System from the Encryption pick list.
b. Tap Done when configuration is complete, then tap OK to return to the
Spectrum24 Preferences screen.
c. Tap Connect to connect to the network.
8. For WEP Configuration:
WEP uses an encryption key to perform a checksum on the original message. To
configure WEP:
a. Select either 40-Bit Shared Key or 128-Bit Shared Key from the Encryption pick
list.
b. Select Key Index.
c. Enter the encryption keys in Key1 through Key 4 fields.
d. Tap Done when configuration is complete, then tap OK to return to the
Spectrum24 Preferences screen.
e. Tap Connect to connect to the network.
9. For Kerberos Configuration:
Kerberos uses an authorization key to authenticate users/clients in a wireless
network environment and to securely distribute the encryption keys used for both
encrypting and decrypting plain text. To configure Kerberos:
a. Select Kerberos from the Encryption pick list. The following screen appears:
Note: If your terminal does not have the correct
Spectrum24 firmware, the following message
appears. Consult with your system
administrator.
2-10
Network Setup
b. Tap the Details button. The Kerberos Details screen appears.
c. Enter the settings provided by your system administrator.
d. Tap the Advanced button. The Kerberos Advanced screen appears:
e. Enter the settings provided by your system administrator.
f. Tap the Done button to return to the previous screen.
g. Tap the Done button to return to the Spectrum24 Preferences screen.
h. Tap Connect to connect to the network.
Configuring a CDPD WAN Connection
(SPT 1833 Only)
Before the SPT 1833 terminal can be used, you need to be activated on a CDPD network.
All CDPD identification and address information is entered through the Preferences
application on the SPT 1833 terminal. To configure your SPT 1833 terminal for use on a
2-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
CDPD network, tap the
displays:
icon from the Applications Launcher. The main Merlin screen
Setup Wizard
The first time that the MerlinTM Modem Manager software is started the Setup Wizard will
display and prompt you through the steps to configure and set up the terminal for operation.
Note: If this is not the first time you are accessing the Merlin Modem
Manager, tap the
icon and select Setup Wizard from the Merlin
menu.
At any time, you can choose to cancel the Setup Wizard and exit back to the Application
Launcher by tapping the Cancel button. If you do choose to cancel, the Setup Wizard will
be displayed the next time that the Modem Manager is selected. It is recommended that
once you begin the setup process you continue through to its completion.
2-12
Network Setup
1. To begin configuration, tap Next. The Network Provider screen displays:
2. Select a Wireless Provider from the pick list:
3. Tap Other if you need to enter a Service Provider Interface number representing a
different carrier. The following screen displays:
4. Enter the SPI number and tap Done.
5. The Network Provider screen reappears. Tap Next to continue.
Note: The Setup Wizard will not proceed until a CDPD carrier selection
has been made.
2-13
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
6. The Configure Palm Device screen displays:
7. Tap the Configure Preferences button to configure the terminal with the network
library settings that Symbol recommends. A “Palm Configuration Complete”
message will display below the Configure Preferences button when the process is
finished.
Note: If you are confident that the Network Preferences are correct, you
may bypass this step. However, it strongly suggested that you verify
preference configuration.
8. Tap Next to continue. The Contact A Provider screen displays:
You are informed that you will need an IP address and two DNS addresses from
your Network Provider before continuing.
2-14
Network Setup
9. Tap Next to continue. The Settings screen displays:
10. Enter the required information and tap Next to continue. You are prompted to
confirm the settings. Verify the information you entered is accurate and tap Next.
11. Once the modem has been configured, the Auto Config screen displays:
Tap to attempt
connection with the
network now
Tap ifi you are going to
wait for your account
to be registered
Tapping either button displays the Check Network screen as the modem attempts
to register.
2-15
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
12. When the modem connects successfully and the following screen displays:
2-16
Network Setup
Maintenance Screens and Menus
The SPT 1833 terminal includes menu commands to make it fast and easy to configure and
check the status of your modem. This section explains the menu commands specific to the
Merlin Modem Manager.
Quick Status Screen
The initial Merlin Modem Manager screen displays numerous modem parameters. These
include the detection of a CDPD channel and whether the modem has successfully
registered. The modem's status is updated every 3 seconds.
Setting
Description
Cellular Signal
Present
When checked, it indicates that the modem has identified a
cellular signal.
CDPD Service
Detected
When checked, it indicates that the modem has identified and
is synchronized to a CDPD signal in the area.
Modem Ready
Registered
When checked, it indicates that the modem has successfully
registered with a CDPD service provider in the coverage area.
When the indicator is lit a working data connection exists and
can be used by other applications to transmit and receive
data. Until this checkbox is selected, the modem can neither
transmit nor receive data.
RSSI
Measures Received Signal Strength from the wireless base
station. These values range from one to ten bars. The greater
the number of bars, the better the performance of the modem.
Error Detect
When checked, it indicates that a large number of errors have
been detected by the modem. Under these circumstances the
modem may continue to operate but with a severely reduced
performance, caused by the increased likelihood of
connection retries and data errors when communicating with
the wireless base station.
System Busy
When checked, it indicates that the currently detected CDPD
system is busy. The modem may continue to operate but at a
decreased level of performance.
Wireless Provider
Displays the CDPD channel’s System Provider’s Identifier.
2-17
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Setting
Description
RF Channel
Shows the CDPD channel that is currently active. If the unit is
not registered or is searching for a channel, the value
displayed will be either "Searching A" or "Searching B”,
depending on the state of the modem. Once a channel has
been detected, a numeric value for the channel is displayed.
Registration Error
This shows either “None” or a numeric value between 1 and
7. If “None” is displayed there was a successful registration
without any errors. If a numeric error code is displayed then an
error has occurred. Tap to display details about the error.
Shutdown
Turns the modem off.
Merlin Menu Options
Tapping the Menu key provides a series of menus. Merlin Modem Manager software
supports shortcuts to access any of the menus. The following are the available menu
options.
Merlin Menu
Disconnect
Terminates the active Network session with the modem. If
disconnected, the Merlin Modem Manager can no longer perform
3-second updates.
Shutdown
Performs the same function as Disconnect.
Terminates the active Network session with the modem and
forces the modem to power off. If the modem is shutdown, the
Merlin Modem Manager can no longer perform 3-second updates.
Reconnect
Reconnects a network session that has previously been
disconnected. When Reconnect is selected, the 3-second
updates of the software begin again.
2-18
Network Setup
Network Prefs
Brings the user directly to the Network Preferences screen. Refer
to Chapter 13, Applications: Preferences for details.
Setup Wizard
Launches the Setup Wizard to configure your modem.
Advanced Menu
Config
(Configuration)
Displays the network connection configuration screen, allowing
you to make the desired changes or refinements to your network
settings. Refer to Configuration Screen on page 2-20 for detailed
information.
Status
Displays the Detailed Status screen, which shows various details
about how your modem is connecting to a Network or the
Internet. This screen is used for diagnostic purposes and for
assisting customer service in diagnosing any problems you may
encounter with Network connections. Refer to Status Screen on
page 2-23 for detailed information.
Terminal
Displays the terminal emulator, allowing you to connect to and
send AT commands to the modem. Refer to Terminal Screen on
page 2-25 for detailed information.
Ping
Displays the Ping screen, allowing you to send a packet to a
particular IP address to determine if it is online. Refer to Ping
Screen on page 2-26 for detailed information.
2-19
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Configuration Screen
You can select any of the buttons, or triggers, and modify their settings. Note that none of
your changes will become active until you tap the Save button. When Save is selected, you
are provided with the Disconnecting and Reconnecting screens, indicating that the settings
are being saved and the modem is being reset with the new settings. The Save button also
returns you to the Quick Status screen.
IP Address
This is the current IP address of the modem. Tap to enter a new
IP address.
Primary DNS
This is the current Primary DNS address of the modem. Tap to
enter a new DNS address.
Secondary DNS
This is the current Secondary DNS address of the modem. Tap
to enter a new DNS address.
Sleep Mode
Allows or disallows the modem to enter the low-power mode.
Please note that this feature is only functional when used on
Wireless IP networks that support it.
Network Provider
Configure the side preferences for the modem. All CDPD
systems are categorized into “A” systems or “B” systems. This
setting determines which system category (categories). The
modem will search for a CDPD system among the two system
category choices. Refer to Network Provider pick list on page
2-21 for detailed information.
SPI, SPNI, WASI
Configures all identification values for a particular system or
Wireless IP network. Also called Service ID parameters.
2-20
Network Setup
Service ID Pref
Configures the preferences for the service ID parameters.
Refer to Network Provider pick list on page 2-21 for detailed
information.
Channel Hot List
Configures a list of channels upon which the modem will
attempt to find service. This user-configurable list can contain
up to 32 channels, listed in the particular order that you want the
modem to use.
Hot List Operation Configures how the Channel Hot List entered is used.
Sleep Mode pick list
Enabled
The modem will attempt to enter a low-power mode if it is not required to
carry out any communications with a Network. The modem may respond
sluggishly to the first communication request when it is required again.
Disabled
The modem is not allowed to enter sleep mode.
Network Provider pick list
A only
The modem will search for a CDPD system on the "A" side only. For users
who do not roam, this selection can sometimes speed the registration
process, as the modem does not have to look on the "B" side as well
before it can register.
B only
Same as "A only" except on the "B" side.
Prefer A
The modem will search for a CDPD system on the "A" side first and
attempt registration on any system it finds. However, if the modem cannot
register on the "A" side, it will then attempt to find service on the "B" side.
For users who roam, this setting would be appropriate if the home system
was on the "A" side.
Prefer B
The modem will search for a CDPD system on the "B" side first and
attempt registration on any system it finds. However, if the modem cannot
register on the "B" side, it will then attempt to find service on the "A" side.
For users who roam, this setting would be appropriate if the home system
was on the "B" side.
2-21
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Service ID Pref pick list
Only SvcID
The modem will attempt to detect only the system in the Service
ID parameters for registration. This is useful in cases where the
user wishes to prevent roaming to any other system but his home
one.
PreferSvcId The modem will first attempt to register on the system described
by the SPI/WASI/SPNI entries. If no system is found, the modem
will attempt to register on the remaining available systems in the
area. This is useful in situations where the user spends most of his
time in one area and occasionally roams. In this case, the user
would enter the Network ID parameters that reflect the system he
most often will register on. Another situation where this may be
useful is in cases where the user has two systems in his area but
prefers service on one due to rate advantages, etc.
IgnoreSvcID The modem will attempt to register on any system but that
reflected in the Network ID entries. This is useful in situations
where the user wishes to block registration on systems in his area
that he does not have an agreement with. This may speed up the
registration process in some areas.
Any SvcID
2-22
The SPI/WASI/SPNI entries are ignored. This is the default
configuration and ensures that the modem will attempt to register
on any valid system that it can find.
Network Setup
Hot List Operation pick list
Scan All
Ignores the list of channels and searches all of them.
Use List
Attempts to search for system on the channels in the list. If service
cannot be found on those channels, the user will be unregistered.
Hybrid
Attempts to search for systems on the given channels first, and
then opens the search up to all channels if none can be found.
Given this selection, the modem will also update the channel list
automatically with any channel on which it has found service. In
this way, the channel list is eventually updated with all CDPD
systems in the area.
Status Screen
The Status screen shows modem information which is updated every 3 seconds.This
screen was designed to assist support personnel in diagnosing problems with your modem.
If a problem develops, the Symbol Support Center (Refer to Symbol Support Center on
page xv for contact information) will find the information displayed here of importance.
Note: There are no menus on this screen and no place for user entry.
Tapping Done will return you to the Quick Status screen.
CDPD Entry identifies the current CDPD acquisition state.
SEARCH
The modem is searching for service.
2-23
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
ACQ'D
The modem has acquired or synchronized to a CDPD system in
the area.
RSSI Entry is the signal strength measured on the current channel. During the SEARCH
phase of operation, this value may vary according to the channel on which an attempt will
be made. When ACQ'D, the signal strength measurement should remain somewhat
constant.
Color
Area color code being transmitted by the CDPD system.
Chan
The current channel. During the SEARCH phase, this value may
change according to the channel that is being attempted. Once a
channel has been ACQ'D, this should remain relatively constant.
CellID
CDPD Base Station identifier number.
BLER
A measurement of the error rate on the forward channel detected by
the modem.
Side
Display of the current Side, given the A/B side distribution of the CDPD
channels.
PL
The current Power Level value at which transmission will take place.
SPI
The current CDPD Base Station Service Provider Identifier.
WASI
The current CDPD Base Station Wide Area Service Identifier.
SPNI
The current CDPD Base Station Service Provider Network Identifier.
PwrProd
The Power Product value transmitted by the current CDPD system.
RegErr
A numeric value representing the last registration error encountered. A
value of 1-7 indicates an error; a value of 0 indicates no error and a
value of 255 indicates no registration attempt was made.
Link
Identifies the current CDPD communication link state. Can be Locked
or Searching.
IP is the IP address of the unit.
EID is the Equipment ID of the unit.
2-24
Network Setup
Terminal Screen
The Terminal provides an internal terminal emulator for communication with the modem,
allowing users to further customize the operation of their modem based on the AT
command set.
To begin a terminal session:
1. Tap the Online button.
Going online terminates any active network session and establishes a serial
session to the modem.
The screen shows the data that is being received from the modem. As data is
received, it is displayed line by line on the screen display. Scroll bars automatically
display when the amount of displayed data exceeds the physical size of the SPT
1833 terminal’s total display area. You can scroll back and forth through most of the
previously displayed data. There is a physical limitation on how much previous data
can be scrolled and once this limitation is reached, the oldest data will be
overwritten, so the screen buffer always maintains the last 2000 bytes of data from
the modem.
2. Tap Offline button to close the serial session.
3. Tap Done to terminate any serial session and re-establish a network session,
returning you to the Quick Status screen.
4. Tap the Clear button to clear the current screen buffer.
At the bottom of the screen is a field for entry of an AT command. There are a number
of pre-defined commands that are included in the Cmd pick list. When you selection of
any of these commands, the modem will automatically send the command, without the
need to press Send button.
2-25
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Ping Screen
From this screen you can send a PING request to another network device whose network
address you already know. This is useful to verify network connectivity.
As with other PING applications, you must enter the IP address of the other network device
in the IP field and then select the desired payload size. Pressing the Send button will send
the PING. A status line will provide information on whether or not the PING was successful
by displaying a "Success" or "Fail" message. There is a 20 second timeout for a response
before a "Success" or "Fail" message may display.
Please note that there are some limitations on this PING implementation:
•
The size of PING payload is limited to 99 bytes. If a payload of greater than that is
entered, a data error message will be displayed.
•
The delay to wait for response is fixed at 20 seconds.
After you have viewed this information, press the OK button to return to the Quick Status
screen.
Help Menu
The Help menu shows basic information about your modem, modem driver, and Merlin
application.
Modem Info
2-26
Displays the Quick Status screen. Refer to 2-17 for
details.
Network Setup
Driver Info
Displays the version of the modem driver.
About
Displays version and copyright information for Merlin.
2-27
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
2-28
Chapter 3
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Changing the Applications Launcher Display Format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Switching Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Setting Preferences for Applications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Displaying Applications by Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Writing Graffiti 2 with the Stylus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Practicing Graffiti 2 with the Memo Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
General Guidelines for Graffiti 2 Writing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Using the On-Screen Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15
Using Application Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Using Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18
Choosing a Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18
Graffiti 2 Menu Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Edit Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Choosing Fonts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
Using Categories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21
Using Categories in Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22
Defining a New Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23
Renaming Categories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25
Attaching Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26
Marking Private Entries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26
Beaming Information to Other SPT 1800 Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
Scanning with the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29
3-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
3-2
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Introduction
This chapter explains how to open applications, use the on-screen keyboard, write with the
stylus, perform scanning, and use common features on your SPT 1800 terminal.
Applications
Your SPT 1800 terminal is equipped with a variety of applications which display in the
Applications Launcher. Use the Applications Launcher to open any application installed on
your SPT 1800 terminal. You can also open the four main applications — Date Book,
Address Book, To Do List and Memo Pad — with the buttons on the front panel of your SPT
1800 terminal.
Tip: The buttons on the front panel provide instant access to the selected
application. You don’t need to turn on your SPT 1800 terminal first.
The Applications Launcher also displays the current time, battery level and application
category.
To open applications:
1. Tap the
icon on the SPT 1800 terminal screen to open the Applications
Launcher.
2. Tap the icon of the application that you want to open. If you have many applications
installed on your SPT 1800 terminal, tap the scroll bar to see all of your
applications.
Tip: As a shortcut, write the Graffiti 2 handwriting software character stroke for the
first letter of the application you want to use. The Applications Launcher scrolls to
3-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
the first application that begins with that letter. Refer to Writing Graffiti 2 with the
Stylus on page 3-6 for additional information.
Changing the Applications Launcher Display Format
By default the Applications Launcher displays each application as an icon. As an
alternative, you can choose to show a list of applications.
To change the Applications Launcher display:
1. Tap the
icon on the SPT 1800 terminal screen to open the Applications
Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher menus.
3. Tap Preferences from the Options menu to open the Preferences screen.
4. Tap the View By pick list and select the List option.
Note: Tap the Remember Last Category checkbox to display only the last
category of applications that you have selected.
5. Tap the OK button to close the Preferences screen and display the Applications
Launcher in list format.
Switching Applications
When working in any application, you can tap the
icon or press the buttons on the front
panel to switch to any other application. Your SPT 1800 terminal saves your work in the
current application and displays it when you return to the current screen.
3-4
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Setting Preferences for Applications
You can set preferences for individual applications in the Preferences screen. Not all
applications have preference settings.
To set preferences for an application:
1. Open an application.
2. Tap the Menu icon.
3. From the Options menu, select Preferences.
4. Enter the desired preference settings; then tap OK.
Displaying Applications by Category
The category feature enables you to limit the number of applications that display on the
screen. You can assign your applications to categories and then choose to display a single
category or all your applications.
To display applications by category:
1. Tap the
icon on the SPT 1800 terminal screen to open the Applications
Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher menus.
3. Tap Category from the App menu to open the Category screen.
4. Tap the pick list next to each application to assign it to a category.
3-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Tip: To create a new category, tap Edit Category from the pick list to open the Edit
Categories screen. Tap the New button, enter the category name, and then tap the
OK button to add the category. Tap OK to close the Edit Categories screen.
5. Tap the Done button to close the Category screen and return to the Applications
Launcher.
6. Tap the pick list in the upper-right corner of the screen and select the application
category you want to display.
Tip: You can also tap the
icon to scroll through the application categories.
Writing Graffiti 2 with the Stylus
Your SPT 1800 terminal includes Graffiti 2 handwriting software as the primary system for
entering text and numbers. Graffiti 2 is a system where simple strokes you write with the
stylus are instantly recognized as letters or numbers.
This section explains the basics of Graffiti 2, and how to make strokes in the Graffiti 2
writing area. Your SPT 1800 terminal also includes Giraffe — a game you can use to
practice writing Graffiti 2. Refer to Installing Applications on page 16-3 for instructions on
how to install Giraffe.
Practicing Graffiti 2 with the Memo Pad
The Memo Pad application is ideal for practicing the Graffiti 2 alphabet. This section
explains how to open the Memo Pad and use it to practice Graffiti 2. A complete
explanation of the Memo Pad application appears in Chapter 8, Applications: Memo Pad.
To open the Memo Pad application:
1. Press the
application.
3-6
button on the front of your SPT 1800 terminal to open the Memo Pad
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
2. Tap the New button to open a new Memo Page.
New
memo
cursor
Tap
New
Write in Graffiti 2 area
Note: A cursor displays in the upper-left corner of the Memo Page to
indicate where new text will display.
General Guidelines for Graffiti 2 Writing
Follow these guidelines to learn and use Graffiti 2 writing strokes successfully:
•
To achieve 100% accuracy, practice drawing characters exactly as they appear in
the tables later in this chapter.
•
The heavy dot on each shape indicates where to start the stroke. Some characters
have similar shapes, but different starting and ending points. Always start the
stroke at the heavy dot. (Do not draw the heavy dot; it is there only as a guideline.)
•
The Graffiti 2 writing strokes for letters closely resemble letters of the standard
English alphabet, both upper case and lower case. Graffiti 2 includes symbols
made with a single stroke and symbols made with multiple strokes.
For multi-stroke characters, a temporary character is displayed after the first
stroke, to show that the stroke was recognized. For example, after the first vertical
3-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
stroke of “t”, a temporary “l” is shown. There is a limited time window, during which
the second stroke must be drawn. Otherwise the temporary stroke is recorded.
•
The text input area is divided into two parts, one for writing lowercase letters and
one for writing numbers. The small marks at the top and bottom of the text input
area define the division line. To have your terminal recognize letters and numbers,
you must begin letter strokes on the left side, and number strokes on the right side
of the text input area. Uppercase letters are formed by writing across the division
line.
Write letters here
Write numbers here
Division marks
To write Graffiti 2 letters:
1. Tap the screen where you want to write your text (an entry in your Data Book, an
e-mail address, etc.).
Note: A blinking cursor must display onscreen above the Graffiti 2 writing
area before you can begin writing text.
2. Use the The Graffiti 2 Alphabet on page 3-10 to find the stroke shape for the letter
you want to create. For example, the stroke shown below creates the letter “n.”
Note: There are two different stroke shapes available for some letters. For
these letters, choose the one that’s easiest for you.
Lift stylus here
Start stroke at
heavy dot
3-8
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
As you’ll see later, you use these shapes to create both upper- and lowercase
letters.
1. Position the stylus in the appropriate place of the text input area.
2. Start your stroke at the heavy dot, and draw the stroke shape as it displays in the
tables.
Note: Don’t try to draw the dot shape itself. The heavy dot is there to show
the starting point of the stroke.
3. Lift the stylus from the screen at the end of the stroke shape.
4. Your terminal recognizes your stroke immediately and displays the letter at the
insertion point onscreen. As soon as you lift the stylus from the screen, you can
begin the stroke for the next character you want to write.
Graffiti 2 Tips
When using Graffiti 2 writing, keep the following tips in mind:
•
For greater accuracy, draw letters with large strokes; strokes that nearly fill the text
input area are easily interpreted.
•
To delete characters, set the insertion point to the right of the character you want
to delete, and draw the Backspace stroke (a line from right to left) in the text input
area.
•
Write at natural speed. Writing too slowly can produce errors.
•
Do not write at a slant. Keep vertical strokes parallel to the sides of the text input
area.
•
When letters and numbers can be written using two different strokes, use the one
that’s easiest for you.
•
Press firmly.
3-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
The Graffiti 2 Alphabet
Draw Graffiti 2 letters according to the following alphabet.
Write lowercase letters here
Write uppercase letters across these division marker
Write numbers here
Writing Punctuation Marks and Other Special Characters
Using Graffiti 2 writing, you can create any punctuation symbol and special character
available from a standard keyboard.
•
3-10
The period and comma punctuation marks can be written on either side of the text
input area (the letter or number side). Other common punctuation marks can be
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
written on one side of the text input area according to the chart below (in general,
the more frequently used punctuation is on the left side).
Note that the punctuation characters are can also be entered anywhere on the text input
area if you first use the shift character. This requires an additional shift stroke, but you may
find it more convenient, since you don’t have to remember on which side of the input area
to make the stroke.
•
When writing letters with accent marks, first write the letter stroke on the left side
(or in the center for uppercase letters) of the input area. Then quickly write the
accent stroke on the right side of the input area, as shown in the illustration below.
•
Symbols and other special characters can be written using the Shift command.
When you make a vertical stroke from the bottom to the top in the text input area,
the Shift indicator arrow appears in the lower right corner of the screen. While this
arrow is visible, you can make the punctuation shift characters shown in the
illustration below. Once the arrow goes away, the punctuation mark appears.
Tip:Using an additional Shift stroke to finish writing the character (as shown in the
demo) is optional, but will make the character appear more quickly.
3-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Draw punctuation, symbols or accent marks using the following strokes:
Tip:Samples of the character strokes are available in the Graffiti 2 Help file. To view
the Help file, use the full-screen pen stroke, dragging the stylus from the text input
area to the top of the screen. Note that the accented characters appear on a
Punctuation Shift screen, but do not use the Shift command. To write uppercase
accented characters, write the letter across the division mark, just as you would do
with an ordinary letter.
Using the Graffiti 2 Tuner
The Graffiti 2 tuner provides alternate strokes for making the T, P, Y, and $ characters. For
example, you may want to form the letter “T” by using strokes similar to a space and an “L”.
But if this technique is difficult to control, you can turn off this option.
To use the tuner:
1. Tap the Applications icon.
2. In the pick list in the upper right corner of the screen, tap Main or System.
3. Tap on the Prefs icon.
3-12
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
4. Select Graffiti 2 from the pick list in the upper right corner of the screen.
5. Tap on one of the letters available for you to tune:
Using Graffiti 2 Gestures
Gestures are editing commands, such as cut, paste, and the ShortCut command which will
be explained in the next section. To use gestures, draw the following strokes:
Using Graffiti 2 ShortCuts
Graffiti 2 ShortCuts let you quickly and easily enter commonly used words or phrases.
ShortCuts are similar to the Glossary or Autotext features of some word processors.
Graffiti 2 writing comes with several predefined ShortCuts. You can also create your own,
for any words, letters, or numbers.
3-13
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
You can create ShortCuts, with up to 45 characters, using the ShortCut preferences. For
example, you could create a ShortCut for your name or for the header of a memo. All
ShortCuts you create appear on the list in the ShortCut Preferences screen, are available
in any of your terminal applications, and are backed up on your computer when you perform
a HotSync® operation.
Your terminal includes the following predefined Graffiti 2 ShortCuts for common entries:
•
ds—Date stamp
•
ts—Time stamp
•
dts—Date/time stamp
•
me—Meeting
•
br—Breakfast
•
lu—Lunch
•
di—Dinner
To use a ShortCut:
Draw the ShortCut stroke, followed by the ShortCut character or characters.
When you draw the ShortCut stroke, the ShortCut symbol appears at the insertion point.
ShortCut
ut
To create a ShortCut:
1. Tap the Applications icon.
2. Select All or System from the pick list in the upper right corner.
3. Select Prefs from the menu.
4. Tap ShortCuts in the pick list in the upper right corner.
5. Tap New.
3-14
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
6. In the ShortCut Name line of the ShortCut Entry screen, enter the letters you want
to use to activate the ShortCut.
Tap New.
7. Tap the ShortCut Text area, then enter the text that will appear when you write the
ShortCut characters.
8. You can add a space character after the last word in your ShortCut text, so that a
space automatically follows the ShortCut text.
9. Tap OK.
To edit a ShortCut:
1. In the ShortCut Preferences screen, tap the ShortCut you want to edit.
2. Tap Edit.
3. Make the changes you want; then tap OK.
To delete a ShortCut:
1. In the ShortCut Preferences screen, tap the ShortCut you want to delete.
2. Tap Delete; then tap Yes.
Using the On-Screen Keyboard
You can activate the on-screen keyboard any time you need to enter text or numbers on
your SPT 1800 terminal as an alternative to Graffiti 2. Note that you cannot enter Graffiti 2
characters while using the on-screen keyboard.
To use the on-screen keyboard:
1. Open any SPT 1800 terminal application (such as the Memo Pad application, as
described in the previous section).
2. Tap any record name, or tap the New button.
3-15
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
3. Tap the left target to open the Alpha keyboard, or tap the right target to open the
Numeric keyboard.
Tap abc for alphabet
keyboard.
Tap 123 for numeric
keypad.
Alpha
Tab
Backspace
Caps lock
Carriage return
Caps shift
Tap here to display
Alpha keyboard
Numeric
Tap here to display
Numeric keyboard
International
Tap here to display
International keyboard
4. Tap the characters of the on-screen keyboard to enter text and numbers.
Note: The on-screen keyboard also includes a dialog for international
characters. You can switch among the three dialogs at any time to
enter the exact text you need.
After you finish, tap the Done button to close the on-screen keyboard and place the text in
your SPT 1800 terminal application.
3-16
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Using Application Controls
SPT 1800 applications include several types of controls. Once you become familiar with
these controls, you can easily select options and navigate through your SPT 1800 terminal
applications. The following table lists the controls and how to use them.
Check box. When a check mark displays in a check
box, the corresponding option is active. If a check
box is empty, tap it to insert a check mark. If a check
box is checked, tapping it removes the check mark.
Scroll arrows.Tap the up arrow to display the
previous page of information, or tap the down arrow
to display the next page. These arrows perform the
same function as pressing the upper and lower
portions of the scroll button on the front panel of the
SPT 1800 terminal.
Pick list.Tap the arrow to display a list of choices,
and then tap an item on the list to select it.
Button.Tap a button to perform a command. Buttons
display with different text depending on their function.
In most cases, tapping a button opens or closes a
dialog. A dialog is a screen that displays on your SPT
1800 terminal, prompting you to enter information or
make settings. A dialog always contains an OK,
Cancel or Done button, so you can close the dialog
when you are through with it. The on-screen
keyboard is an example of a dialog.
Scroll bar. Drag the slider to scroll the display one
line at a time. To scroll to the previous page, tap the
arrow at the top of the scroll bar. To scroll to the next
page, tap the arrow at the bottom of the scroll bar.
3-17
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Using Menus
Menus are a special set of commands available in most of your SPT 1800 terminal
applications (Memo Pad, Date Book, etc.). The exact commands that display in the menus
depend on the application that is currently running on your SPT 1800 terminal.
Some menu commands are common to all SPT 1800 terminal applications. These are
described in this section; other menu commands are described in the chapters about each
SPT 1800 terminal application.
To activate the menus:
1. Open an SPT 1800 terminal application (such as the Memo Pad, as described
earlier in this chapter).
2. Tap the
icon to open the menus for the application at the top of the screen.
Tap the Menus icon
In this example, three menus are available: Record, Edit and Options. The Record menu is
selected and contains the “New Memo,” “Delete Memo” and “Beam Memo” commands.
Choosing a Menu
After you activate the menus for an application, tap the menu that contains the command
you want to use.
The menus and menu commands available depend on the application currently running on
your SPT 1800 terminal, and vary depending on which part of the application is currently
3-18
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
on the screen. Using the Memo Pad application as an example, the menus are different for
the Memo List screen and the Memo screen.
Graffiti 2 Menu Commands
Most menu commands have Graffiti 2“Command stroke” equivalents — similar to keyboard
commands on computers. The command letters display on the right side of the menu
commands.
To use the Graffiti 2 menu commands, draw the Command stroke followed by the
corresponding command letter.
Command
When you draw the Command stroke, the Command Bar displays just above the Graffiti 2
writing area to indicate that you are in Command mode. The command bar is displayed for
approximately 4 seconds.
Tap an icon that represents the command you want, or enter the shortcut for the command
in the input text area below the Command toolbar. For example, to choose Select All in the
Edit menu, draw the command stroke in the text area to display the Command toolbar; then
draw the letter S. Note that if you wait more than three seconds to draw the shortcut letter,
you’ll have to redraw the command stroke to redisplay the Command toolbar.
Note: You do not have to tap the
icon or access the menus when you
use the Graffiti 2 menu commands. However, since the Command
mode is active for approximately four seconds, you must write the
letter character immediately to activate the menu command.
Edit Menu Commands
The Edit menu is available with any screen where you enter or edit text. In general, the Edit
Menu commands available in the Edit menu apply to text that you select in an application.
3-19
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To select text in an application:
1. Tap the beginning of the text that you want to select.
2. Drag the stylus over the text to highlight it (in black).
Note: You can drag across the text to select additional words, or drag
down to select a group of lines.
The following commands may display in an Edit menu:
Undo
Reverses the action of the last edit command. For example, if you used
the Cut command to remove text, the Undo command replaces the text
you removed.
Cut
Removes the selected text and stores it temporarily in the memory of
your SPT 1800 terminal. You can paste the cut text into another area of
the application or into a different application.
Copy
Copies the selected text and stores it temporarily in the memory of your
SPT 1800 terminal. You can paste the copied text into another area of
the application or into a different application.
Paste
Inserts the text that you cut or copied at the selected point in your SPT
1800 terminal application. The Paste command replaces any selected
text. If you did not previously cut or copy text, the Paste command does
nothing.
Select All
Selects all of the text on the current record or screen. This enables you
to cut or copy all of the text and paste it elsewhere.
Keyboard
Opens the on-screen keyboard. When you finish with the on-screen
keyboard, tap the Done button.
Graffiti 2 Help
Opens the dialogs that show the Graffiti 2 character strokes. Use this
command any time you forget a stroke for a particular character.
Choosing Fonts
In most of your SPT 1800 terminal applications, you can change the font style to make the
text on the screen easier to read. You can even choose a different font style for each
application that supports this feature.
3-20
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Note: The Expense application does not support changing fonts.
To change the font style:
1. Open a SPT 1800 terminal application.
2. Tap the
icon to open the menus at the top of the screen.
3. Tap Font from the Options menu to open the Select Font screen.
Tap here for large font
Tap here for bold font
Tap here for small font
4. Tap the font style you want to use.
5. Tap the OK button to close the screen and return to the application with the new
font style.
Small font
Large font
Bold font
3-21
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Using Categories
Categories can help you group Address entries, To Do items, Memos, and Expense
application records for easy review. You cannot, however, assign categories to Date Book
events.
When you first create an entry, it is automatically assigned to the currently displayed
category. For example, if a record is created while the Personal category is displayed, the
record is assigned to the Personal category. If a record is created while the All category is
displayed, it will be designated as “Unfiled,” which means it does not belong to any
particular category. You can leave an entry as Unfiled or assign it to a category at any time.
Either way, the entry is always available until you delete it. The category you choose is used
only for sorting and reviewing records, and does not affect the actual contents of the record.
Note: The use of categories is optional. You do not need to assign
categories to use SPT 1800 terminal applications.
To assign a category to an entry:
1. Tap a To Do item, Memo, Expense record or an Address Book entry.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Details screen (for an Address Book entry, you
then tap the Edit button).
3. Tap the Category pick list to display a list of available categories.
4. Tap the category that you want to assign to the entry.
5. Tap the OK button to close the Details screen and activate your setting.
Using Categories in Lists
After you assign categories to your entries, you can easily display lists of your entries by
category.
3-22
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
To use categories in a List screen:
1. Tap the category pick list in the upper-right corner of the List screen.
Tap here
2. Tap the category of entries that you want to view. The List screen changes to show
only the records filed in that selected category.
3. Repeat the previous steps, and tap All in the category pick list to restore the list of
all Address Book entries.
Tip: Pressing the application button on the front panel of the SPT 1800 terminal
toggles through the available categories.
Defining a New Category
Your SPT 1800 terminal comes with two default categories: Business and Personal. In
addition, the Address Book contains the QuickList category, designed as a “quick
reference” of commonly used names, addresses and phone numbers (such as doctor,
lawyer, etc.).
You can change the names of these default categories, or add new categories to suit your
needs. You can define up to 15 categories for each application.
3-23
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To define a new Address Book category:
1. Tap the category pick list in the upper-right corner of the screen.
Tap here
2. Tap the Edit Categories item to open the Edit Categories screen.
3. Tap the New button to open another Edit Categories screen.
4. Enter the name of the new category, and tap the OK button to close the Edit
Categories screen.
5. Tap the OK button to close the first Edit Categories screen and view your new
category in the pick list.
3-24
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Note: You can edit any of your records and file them in the new categories
as appropriate.
Renaming Categories
You can also use the Edit Categories screen to change the names of any existing category.
To change the name of an Address Book category:
1. Tap the category pick list in the upper-right corner of the screen.
2. Tap the Edit Categories item to open the Edit Categories screen.
3. Tap the category that you want to rename, then tap the Rename button to open
another Edit Categories screen.
4. Enter the new name that you want to assign to the category, and tap the OK button
to close the Edit Categories screen.
5. Tap the OK button to close the first Edit Categories screen and view the new name
in the pick list.
Note: You can “merge” two or more Categories by assigning them the
same name. For example, if you change the name of the “Personal”
category to the name “Business,” all entries formerly in the Personal
category display in the Business category.
3-25
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Attaching Notes
SPT 1800 terminal applications (except the Memo Pad) enable you to attach a note to an
entry. A note is anything that you want to write, and can be up to several thousand
characters long. For example, if you have an appointment in the Date Book application, you
could attach a note with directions to the location.
To attach a note to an entry:
1. Display the entry where you want to add a note.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Details screen.
Note: In the Address Book only, the Edit button is used.
3. Tap the Note button to open the Note screen.
4. Write Graffiti 2 character strokes or the on-screen keyboard for the text you want
to appear in the note. Use the Carriage Return stroke to move down to new lines
in the note.
5. Tap the Done button to close the note and return to the application screen. A note
icon displays at the right side of any item that has a note attached. To review or edit
a note, tap the
icon. To delete a note, tap the
icon, Delete, and then Yes to
confirm.
Note icon
Marking Private Entries
In SPT 1800 terminal applications you can mark individual entries as Private. Private
entries remain visible and accessible until you change the Security setting to hide all Private
entries. Refer to Chapter 14, Applications: Security for complete information about how to
activate and use the SPT 1800 terminal Security settings.
To mark an entry as Private:
1. Display the entry that you want to mark as Private.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Details screen.
3. Select the Private check box to insert a check mark and mark the entry as Private.
3-26
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
The Private Records screen displays:
Beaming Information to Other SPT 1800 Terminals
Your SPT 1800 terminal is equipped with an IR (infrared) port that can “beam” information
to other compatible printers and terminals. The IR port is located on the back of the
terminal. Refer to Parts of the SPT 1800 on page 1-4 for the exact location of the IR port.
Note: If you are using a device other than an SPT 1800 terminal, confirm
that your device includes the required infrared hardware before you
use this feature.
You can beam the following information between SPT 1800 terminals:
•
The current Address Book, Date Book, To Do List or Memo Pad entry
•
All the Address Book, To Do List or Memo Pad entries in the current category
•
A special Address Book entry which you designate as a “business card” (refer to
Beaming Address Entries to Other SPT 1800 Terminals on page 7-10 for details).
•
An application installed in RAM memory.
To beam information:
1. Locate the entry, category, business card or application you want to beam.
2. Tap the
icon.
3. Tap the Beam command from the Record menu to open the Beam Status screen.
4. Point the IR port directly at the IR port of the receiving SPT 1800 terminal.
3-27
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Tip: SPT 1800 terminals transmit data at varying distances up to three ft.,
depending on lighting conditions when IR is activated. For best results, the IR
windows should be aligned and clear of obstacles.
5. Wait for the Beam Status screen to indicate that the transfer is complete before you
continue working on your SPT 1800 terminal.
To receive beamed information:
1. Turn on your SPT 1800 terminal.
2. Point the IR port directly at the IR port of the transmitting SPT 1800 terminal to open
the Beam Status screen.
3. Tap the Yes button to accept the transmission.
4. Wait for the Beam Status screen to indicate that the transfer is complete, then tap
the OK button to display the new entry.
Note: Incoming entries are filed under the “Unfiled” category.
To turn beaming off:
1. Tap the Applications icon, then Prefs.
2. In the pick list in the upper right corner, pick General.
The Beam Receive pick list gives you the options of On or Off.
3-28
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Scanning with the SPT 1800
The SPT 1800 has an integrated laser bar code scanner which, if your unit is configured to
use scanning input, allows you to collect data by scanning bar codes. The SPT 1800
decodes the following bar code types:
•
UPC-A/UPC-E/UPC-E1
•
EAN-8/EAN-13
•
Bookland EAN
•
Code 128
•
UCC/EAN-128
•
ISBT 128
•
Code 39
•
Trioptic Code 39
•
Code 93
•
I 2 of 5
•
D 2 of 5
•
Codabar
•
MSI Plessey.
To scan bar codes with the SPT 1800:
1. Start your scanning application.
2. Aim the scanner at the bar code.
3. Press either the right, left or center scan trigger. Make sure the red scan beam
covers the entire bar code. The green scan LED lights and a beep sounds to
indicate a successful decode.
3-29
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
3-30
Chapter 4
Finding Information With Your SPT 1800
Terminal
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using the Find Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Phone Lookup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Phone Lookup Tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-3
4-3
4-4
4-5
4-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
4-2
Finding Information With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Introduction
This chapter explains how to locate information on your SPT 1800 terminal with the Find
command and the Phone Lookup command.
Using the Find Command
The Find command locates any text that you specify and is available in any SPT 1800
terminal application. You can search for whole words or the beginning letters of a word. The
Find command searches all the data on your SPT 1800 terminal and lists which applications
contain the text.
For example, suppose you want to find a particular name, but aren’t sure where you stored
it. The Find command immediately lists all instances of that name and enables you to jump
directly to the name.
To use the Find command:
1. Tap the
icon from any SPT 1800 terminal application to open the Find screen.
Tip: If you select text in an application before you tap the Find button, the selected
text automatically displays in the Find screen.
2. Enter the text that you want to find in your SPT 1800 terminal.
Note: The Find command is not case-sensitive. In other words, searching
for the name “davidson” also finds “Davidson.” The Find command
also searches the contents of notes.
3. Tap the OK button to display a list of all instances of the text that you specified.
4-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: As your SPT 1800 terminal searches for the text, you can tap the
Stop button to stop the search at any time. For instance, if the entry
you want displays before your SPT 1800 terminal finishes the
search. To continue the search after you tap Stop, tap the Find More
button.
4. Tap the text that you want to review. The selected entry and its corresponding SPT
1800 terminal application display on the screen.
Using Phone Lookup
In addition to using the Find feature to locate text, you can search for and display phone
numbers with the Phone Lookup menu command. After you find a phone number, you can
paste it directly into an SPT 1800 terminal application.
For example, if you want to include a phone number in a memo, use the Phone Lookup
feature to find the phone number and transfer it directly into the memo.
To use the Phone Lookup command:
1. Display the entry where you want to insert a phone number. This can be an event
in the Date Book, a To Do List Item or a memo in the Memo Pad application.
Note: The Phone Lookup feature is not available in the Address Book and
Expense applications.
2. Tap the
4-4
icon to open the menus for your application.
Finding Information With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
3. Tap Phone Lookup from the Options menu to display the Phone Number Lookup
screen.
4. Tap the phone number you want to use.
Note: To find a phone number more quickly, you can enter the first letter of
the name you want to find in the Look Up line at the bottom of the
screen. The list scrolls to the first name that starts with that letter.
You can continue to add letters to narrow your search.
5. Tap the Add button to close the Phone Number Lookup screen and paste the name
and phone number you selected into the entry selected in step 1.
Phone Lookup Tips
You can also use the Graffiti Command stroke “/L” to activate the Phone Lookup feature.
•
You can use Phone Lookup while entering text. For example, to insert the full name
and phone number for someone with the last name “Williams,” write the Graffiti
characters for “Wi”, then the Phone Lookup Command stroke “/L.”
Assuming you have only one Address Book entry that begins with “Wi,” your SPT
1800 terminal inserts the full name “Williams” (and the corresponding phone
number). If you have more than one name that begins with “Wi,” the Phone Lookup
screen displays.
•
The Phone Lookup feature also works for selected text. Drag to highlight the text,
and then write the Phone Lookup Command stroke “/L.” Your SPT 1800 terminal
replaces the selected text and adds the phone number to the name that it finds.
4-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
4-6
Chapter 5
Applications: Calculator
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Opening the Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using the Calculator Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Calculator Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Calculator Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Recent Calculations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-3
5-3
5-3
5-3
5-4
5-5
5-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
5-2
Applications: Calculator
Introduction
The Calculator enables you to perform basic mathematical calculations. You can also store
and retrieve values in the Calculator’s memory.
Opening the Calculator
To open the Calculator tap the
icon.
Using the Calculator Screen
The Calculator performs general mathematical functions including addition, subtraction,
multiplication and division. To use the Calculator screen, tap the Calculator buttons that
appear on the screen.
Special Calculator Buttons
The Calculator includes several buttons to help you perform calculations.
Clears the last number you entered. Use this button if you make a mistake
while entering a number in the middle of a calculation. This button enables
you to re-enter the number without starting the calculation over.
Clears the entire calculation to begin a new calculation.
Toggles the current number between a negative and positive value. If you
want to enter a negative number, enter the number first and then press the
+/- button.
5-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Places the current number into Memory. Each new number you enter with
the M+ button is added to the total already stored in memory. The number
that you add can be either a calculated value, or any number you enter by
pressing the number buttons. Pressing this button has no effect on the
current calculation (or series of calculations); it merely places the value into
memory until it is recalled.
Recalls the stored value from memory and inserts it in the current
calculation.
Removes any value stored in the Calculator memory.
Calculator Menu Commands
The Calculator supports Copy and Paste commands. You can use these commands to
copy a value from the Calculator and paste it into another application on your SPT 1800
terminal. Similarly, you can copy values from other applications on your SPT 1800 terminal,
such as Expense, and paste the values into the Calculator. For additional information on
the Copy and Paste commands, refer to Using Menus on page 3-18.
5-4
Applications: Calculator
Recent Calculations
The Recent Calculations command enables you to review the last series of calculations,
and is particularly useful for confirming a series of “chain” calculations.
To display the Recent Calculations:
1. Tap the
icon to open the Calculator menus.
2. Tap Recent Calculations from the Options menu to display the Recent Calculations
screen.
3. When you finish reviewing the screen, tap the OK button to close the Recent
Calculations screen and return to the Calculator.
5-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
5-6
Chapter 6
Applications: Date Book
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Opening the Date Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Using the Date Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Scheduling an Event. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Rescheduling an Event. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Setting an Alarm for an Event. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Scheduling Repeating Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Marking a Private Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Deleting an Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Changing the Date Book View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Working in Week View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Working in Month View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
Working in Agenda View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
Date Book Menu Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
Record Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19
6-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
6-2
Applications: Date Book
Introduction
The Date Book enables you to quickly and easily schedule appointments or any kind of
activity associated with a time and date.
With the Date Book, you can:
•
Enter a description of your appointment and assign it to a specific time and date.
•
Schedule events by time and /or date, repeating events such as weekly meetings,
and continuous events such as a three day conference.
•
Display a chart of your appointments for an entire week. The Week View feature
makes it easy to spot any potential scheduling overlaps or conflicts. They can also
be displayed by Day, Month, or Agenda.
•
Display a monthly calendar to quickly spot days where you have morning, lunch or
afternoon appointments.
•
Set an alarm to sound prior to the scheduled activity.
•
Create reminders for events that are based on a particular date, rather than time of
day. Birthdays and anniversaries are easy to track with your SPT 1800 terminal.
•
Attach notes to individual events for a description or clarification of the entry in your
Date Book.
Opening the Date Book
To open the Date Book, press the Date Book button on the front panel of the SPT 1800
terminal.
Date Book button
Tip: Press the Date Book button repeatedly to cycle through the Day, Week, Month
and Agenda Views.
6-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Using the Date Book
Each entry in the Date Book is called an event, any kind of activity that you associate with
a day. When the Date Book screen first displays, it shows the current date and a list of times
for a normal business day. You can enter a new event on any of the available time lines.
Scheduling an Event
When you create an event, its description displays on the time line, and its duration is
automatically set to one hour. These are referred to as timed events. You can easily change
the start time and duration for any timed event.
You can also include events in your Date Book that occur on a particular date but have no
specific start or end times, such as birthdays, holidays and anniversaries. These are
referred to as untimed events. Untimed events display at the top of the Date Book screen
with a diamond in the time list. You can have several untimed events on a particular date.
To schedule a timed event for the current day:
1. Tap the time line that corresponds to your event in the Date Book screen.
Tap a time
Time bar
shows
duration
2. Use the stylus to write Graffiti character strokes (or use the on-screen keyboard) to
describe your event. You can enter up to 255 characters.
3. If your appointment is longer or shorter than an hour, tap the time of the event to
open the Set Time screen. If your appointment is one hour long, skip to step 7.
6-4
Applications: Date Book
Note: You can also open the Set Time screen to select a start time by
writing a number on the number side of the Graffiti writing area. No
event can be selected.
Tap the time
of an event
4. Tap the time columns on the right side of the Set Time screen to set the Start Time.
Start Time
highlighted
Tap to scroll to
earlier hours
Tap to change
hours
Tap to set an all
day meeting
Tap to change a
timed event into
an untimed event
Tap to change
minutes
Tap to scroll to
later hours
5. Tap the End Time box, and then tap the time columns to set the End Time.
6. Tap the OK button to confirm your selection and close the Set Time screen.
7. Tap a blank area of the screen to de-select the event. A vertical line displays next
to the time, indicating the duration of the event.
6-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To schedule a timed event for another day:
1. Select the date you want for the event by doing one of the following:
•
Tap the day of the week that you want in the Date Bar at the top of the Date
Book screen. If necessary, tap the Previous week or Next week scroll bars to
move to another week.
Previous
week
Next
week
Tap to select the day of
the current week
•
Tap the Go To button to open the Go to Date screen. Select a date by tapping
a year, month and day in the calendar.
Previous year
Next year
Tap to scroll to
earlier hours
Tap to scroll to
earlier hours
Tap to select
current date
•
Press the scroll button on the front panel of the SPT 1800 terminal to scroll to
another day. Press the upper half of the button to move to the previous day or
the lower half to move to the next day.
2. After you locate the date, follow the steps described in the previous section, To
schedule a timed event for the current day:
Note: You can also add Address Book information to an event using the
Phone lookup option. Refer to Using Phone Lookup on page 4-4 for
details.
6-6
Applications: Date Book
To schedule an untimed event:
1. Select the date that you want for the event as described in the previous section, To
schedule a timed event for another day:
2. Tap New to open the Set Time screen.
3. Tap OK, so that no start or end times are defined for the new event.
Note: You can also create a new untimed event by making sure no event
is selected, then writing letters in the Graffiti writing area.
4. Enter a description for the event (which displays at the top of the Date Book
screen).
New
untimed
event
No time
selected
5. Tap a blank area on the screen to de-select the untimed event.
6-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: If you create an event and decide later that there is no particular start
or end time, you can easily change it to an untimed event. Tap the
time of the event in the Date Book screen, tap the No Time button,
then tap the OK button to confirm your selection and close the Set
Time screen.
Rescheduling an Event
You can easily make changes to your schedule with your SPT 1800 terminal.
To reschedule an event:
1. Tap the event (not the time of the event) you want to reschedule.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Event Details screen for that event.
3. To change the time, tap the Time box and select the new time as described earlier
in this chapter.
4. To change the date, tap the Date box and select the new date as described earlier
in this chapter.
5. Tap the OK button to close the Event Details screen and return to the Date Book
screen.
Setting an Alarm for an Event
The Alarm setting enables you to set an audible alarm for events in your Date Book. You
can set an alarm to sound minutes, hours or days before an event. When you set an alarm,
an
icon displays to the far right of the event with the alarm. When the alarm tone
sounds, a reminder message also displays on the SPT 1800 terminal screen.
The default Alarm setting is 5 minutes before the time of the event, but you can change this
to any number of minutes, hours or days.
6-8
Applications: Date Book
To set an alarm for an event:
1. Tap the event to which you want to assign an alarm.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Event Details screen for that event.
3. Select the Alarm check box in the Event Details screen to activate the alarm. (Refer
to Options Menu on page 6-19 for details about setting alarm options.)
Enter numeric
setting here
Tap here to
select alarm unit
4. Tap the Alarm units pick list to select Minutes, Hours or Days.
5. Select the “5” (default) and enter any number from 0 to 99 (inclusive) as the
numeric alarm setting.
6. Tap the OK button to close the Event Details screen and return to the Date Book
screen.
Note: You can set a silent alarm for an untimed event. In this case, the
alarm triggers at the specified period of minutes, hours or days
before midnight (beginning) of the day of the untimed event. No
audible alarm sounds for an untimed event; instead, the reminder
message displays on the screen of the SPT 1800 terminal.
For example, you could create a reminder for an untimed event that occurs on February
4th. If the alarm reminder is set for 5 minutes, the alarm reminder displays at 11:55 PM on
the night of February 3rd. The reminder remains on the screen until you turn on your SPT
1800 terminal and tap the OK button to dismiss it.
6-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Once an alarm has gone off, you can dismiss the alarm for a 5 minute period using the
Snooze option.
Tap to delay the
alarm for 5 minutes
Scheduling Repeating Events
The Repeat function enables you to schedule events that recur at regular intervals. A
birthday is a good example of an event that repeats annually. Another example would be a
weekly guitar lesson that falls on the same day of the week and the same time of day. After
you enter a repeating event, a
icon displays to the far right of the event.
To schedule a repeating event:
1. Tap anywhere on the text of an event in the Date Book screen.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Event Details screen.
3. Tap the Repeat box in the Event Details screen to open the Change Repeat screen.
Tap the
Repeat
box
4. Tap Day, Week, Month or Year in the Change Repeat screen.
6-10
Applications: Date Book
5. Enter a number that corresponds to how often you want the event to repeat in the
“Every” area. For example, if you select Month and enter the number “2,” the event
repeats every other month.
Tap the
Month
box
6. If you want to specify an ending date for the repeating event, tap the End on pick
list and tap Choose Date. Use the Date Picker to select an end date.
7. Tap the OK button to close the Change Repeat screen and activate your settings.
Considerations for the Repeat Function
•
If you change the start date of a repeating event, your SPT 1800 terminal calculates
the number of days you have moved the event, then automatically changes the end
date to maintain the duration of the repeating event.
•
If you change the repeat interval (e.g., daily to weekly) of a repeating event, past
occurrences (prior to the day on which you change the setting) are left alone and
your SPT 1800 terminal creates a new repeating event.
•
If you change the date of an occurrence of a repeating event (e.g., from January
14th to January 15th) and apply the change to all occurrences, the new date
becomes the start date of the repeating event. Your SPT 1800 terminal adjusts the
end date to maintain the duration of the event.
•
If you change other repeat settings (e.g., time, alarm, private) of a repeating event
and apply the change to all occurrences, your SPT 1800 terminal creates a new
event. The start date of this new event is the day on which the setting is changed.
Past occurrences (prior to the day of the change) are left alone and not changed.
•
If you make a change to one occurrence of a repeating event (e.g., time), that
occurrence no longer shows the Repeat icon.
6-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Marking a Private Event
You can designate a specific event as “private.” When you activate the Security features,
your SPT 1800 terminal hides all private entries and you must enter a password to display
them on the screen.
To mark an event as private:
1. Tap the event you want to mark as private.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Event Details screen for that event.
3. Select the Private check box.
4. Tap the OK button to close the Event Details screen and return to the Date Book
screen.
Deleting an Event
There are three ways to delete an event from the Date Book application: simply delete the
text of the event, use the Menu Commands (described in the Record Menu section later in
this chapter), or use the Event Details screen.
Note: If you delete the text of a repeating event, you delete all instances of
that event. If you use the Menu Command or the Event Details
screen, you can delete one occurrence of the event (as an
exception) or all occurrences.
To delete an event with the Event Details screen:
1. Tap anywhere in the text area of the event to delete.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Event Details screen.
3. Tap the Delete button to open the Delete Event alert.
4. Tap the OK button to confirm you want to delete the event.
6-12
Applications: Date Book
Changing the Date Book View
In addition to displaying the calendar for a specific day, you can also display your Date Book
by the week, month, and agenda.
To toggle through the different views, press the Date Book button repeatedly to display the
next view or select one of the Date Book View icons.
Date Book view icons
To display the current time tap the date in the Date Book title bar to display the current time.
Tap the date
Current time displays
Note: After a few seconds, the title bar reverts to show the date.
Working in Week View
The Week View shows a chart of your events for an entire week. This view lets you quickly
review your appointments and available time slots. The graphical display helps you spot
overlaps and conflicts in your schedule.
To display the Week View:
1. Tap the Week View button in the Date Book screen.
2. Tap the navigation controls to move forward or backward a week at a time, or to
display details of an event.
Note: The Week View also shows untimed events and events that are
before and after the range of times shown.
6-13
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Previous week
Next
week
Bar indicates earlier event
Dot indicates untimed event
Bar indicates later event
Week View button
3. Tap any of the events to show a description of the event.
Event details
Tap to show event details.
Tips for Using Week View
•
To reschedule an event, tap and drag the event to a different time or day.
•
Tap a blank time on any day to move directly to that day with the Day View screen.
•
Tap any of the days and dates that display at the top of the Week View to move
directly to that day without selecting an event.
•
The Week View shows the time span defined by the Start Time and End Time in
the Date Book Preferences settings. If you have an event before or after this time
span, a bar displays at the top or bottom of that day's column, and these onscreen scroll arrows display if your scheduled events go beyond the displayed time
range.
6-14
Applications: Date Book
Spotting Event Conflicts in Week View
With the ability to define specific start and end times for any event, it’s possible to schedule
events that overlap (an event that starts before a previous event finishes).
In this case, any event conflict (time overlap) displays in the Week View as overlapping
bars. The Day View displays bracketed bars to the left of the conflicting times.
Event
conflicts
Working in Month View
The Month View screen shows which days have events scheduled. Dots and lines in the
Month View indicate events, repeating events and untimed events.
Previous/next month
Dashed line indicates continuous event.
Dots on right side indicate events.
Dots below date indicate untimed events.
Month View button
Tips for Using Month View
•
Tap any day that displays in the Month View screen to move directly to that day with
the Day View screen.
6-15
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
•
Tap the arrows at the top to move forward or backward a month.
•
Tap the Go To button to open the Date Picker and choose a different month.
•
When the Month View is on the screen, you can use the scroll button on the front
panel of the SPT 1800 terminal to move between months. Press the upper half of
the button to display the previous month, or press the lower half to display the next
month.
Note: You can control the dots and lines that display in the Month View.
Refer to Options Menu later in this chapter.
Working in Agenda View
The Agenda view shows your appointments, untimed events, and To Do List items in a
single screen. You can also use the Agenda view to check off completed To Do List items.
To display the Agenda View:
1. Tap the Agenda View button in the Date Book screen.
2. Tap the desired event to go to a Day View of any event on the Agenda view screen.
Agenda View button
Tips for Using Agenda View
•
Tap any appointment while in Agenda view to display the Day View of the
appointment.
•
Check off completed To Do List items in the Agenda view, or click a description of
an item to go directly into the To Do List application.
6-16
Applications: Date Book
Date Book Menu Commands
The Date Book includes menu commands to perform common file and editing tasks. This
section explains the menu commands that are specific to the Date Book.
Refer to Using Menus on page 3-18 for information about menu commands common to all
of your SPT 1800 terminal applications.
Record Menu
When you select the Record menu, its commands display on screen.
New Event
Creates an event and opens the Set Time screen where you can
choose start and end times for the new event. If you do not enter start
and end times, it creates a blank untimed event.
Delete Event
Opens an alert screen, prompting you to confirm that you want to
delete the current event. You must tap an event before you use the
Delete Event command. Tap the OK button to delete the event from
your SPT 1800 terminal, or tap the Cancel button to close the alert
screen and keep the event.
Note: By default your SPT 1800 terminal removes the event from the
Date Book, but retains a copy of the event and transfers it to an archive
file on your computer the next time you perform a HotSync operation.
To remove the event completely, clear the Save archive copy on PC
check box.
Attach Note
Opens the Note screen, where you can create a Note for the current
event.
Delete Note
Opens an alert screen, prompting you to confirm that you really want
to delete the Note attached to the event. Tap the OK button to delete
the Note from the memory of your SPT 1800 terminal, or tap the
Cancel button to close the alert screen and return to the Date Book.
6-17
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Purge
Opens an alert screen, prompting you to confirm that you want to
purge events older than a certain time period — based on the current
date on the internal clock on the SPT 1800 terminal. You can use the
Purge command to conserve memory on your SPT 1800 terminal. The
default setting for the Purge alert is to “Save archive copy on PC.” This
setting removes events from the Date Book, but retains copies and
transfers them to an archive file on your computer during the next
HotSync operation.
Note: The Purge command also deletes repeating events if they end
before the date that you activate the Purge command.
Beam Event
Beams the current event to another terminal through the IR port. Refer
to Beaming Information to Other SPT 1800 Terminals on page 3-27 for
more information.
6-18
Applications: Date Book
Options Menu
When you select the Options menu, its commands display on screen.
Font
Opens the Select Font screen where you can choose a different font
(text) style for your Date Book entries. Refer to Choosing Fonts on
page 3-20 for details.
Preferences
Enables you to set the range of times that display in the Date Book,
and to automatically activate alarms for each event.
•
Start/End Time. Enables you to define the start and end times
for the Date Book screens. If the time slots you select do not
fit on one screen, you can tap the arrows to scroll up and
down.
•
Alarm Preset. Automatically sets an alarm for each new
event. The silent alarm for untimed events is defined by
minutes, days or hours before midnight of the date associated
with the event.
•
Alarm Sound. Controls the tone the alarm generates when it
sounds (i.e., Alert, Bird, Concert, Phone, etc.)
•
Remind Me. Defines how many times the alarm sounds. The
choices are: Once, Twice, 3 times, 5 times and 10 times.
•
Play Every. Defines how often the alarm sounds. The choices
are every: Minute, 5 minutes, 10 minutes and 30 minutes.
6-19
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Display Options Allows you to change the Date Book’s appearance and which events
display.
•
Show Time Bars. Activates the time bars that display in the
Day View. The time bars show the duration of an event and
illustrate event conflicts.
•
Compress Day View. Controls how times display in the Day
View. When Compress Day View is off, all time slots display.
When it is on, start and end times display for each event, but
blank time slots toward the bottom of the screen disappear to
minimize scrolling.
•
Month View settings. These check boxes apply to the Month
View of the Date Book. You can activate any or all of these
settings to show that you have Timed, Untimed or Daily
Repeating events in the Month View only.
Phone Lookup
Activates the Phone Lookup feature. Refer to Using Phone Lookup on
page 4-4.
Security
Opens the Change Security screen where you can change the
security of the open memo. Refer to Chapter 14, Applications: Security
for details.
About Date
Book
Shows version (revision) information for the Date Book application.
6-20
Chapter 7
Applications: Address Book
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Opening the Address Book. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Address Book Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Creating an Address Book Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Deleting an Address Book Entry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Duplicating an Address Book Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Working with Address Book Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Beaming Address Entries to Other SPT 1800 Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
Address Book Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Record Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
7-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
7-2
Applications: Address Book
Introduction
The Address Book enables you to keep names, addresses, phone numbers and other
information about your personal or business contacts.
With the Address Book, you can:
•
Quickly look up or enter names, addresses, phone numbers and other information.
•
Enter up to five phone numbers (home, work, fax, car, etc.) or e-mail addresses for
each name.
•
Define which phone numbers appear in the Address List screen for each Address
Book entry.
•
Attach a note to each Address Book entry where you can enter additional
information about the entry.
•
Assign categories to your Address Book entries, so you can quickly sort and view
them in logical groups.
Opening the Address Book
To open the Address Book:
1. Press the Address Book button on the front panel of the SPT 1800 terminal to open
the Address Book and display a record list.
Address Book
Tip: Press the Address Book button repeatedly to cycle through the categories in
which you have records.
7-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Address Book Entries
An Address Book entry is where you store name and address information about people or
businesses. Your SPT 1800 terminal makes it easy to create, edit and delete Address Book
entries.
Creating an Address Book Entry
You can create Address Book entries on your SPT 1800 terminal, or use the Symbol Palm
Terminal Desktop software to create Address Book entries on your computer and download
the entries to your SPT 1800 terminal with the next HotSync operation. Refer to Chapter
10, Applications: HotSync® for details.
Note: The Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software also has data import
capabilities that enable you to load database files into the Address
Book on your SPT 1800 terminal. Refer to the online documentation
supplied with the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software for
details.
To create a new Address Book entry:
1. Press the
List screen.
button on the front of your SPT 1800 terminal to display the Address
2. Tap the New button to display the Address Edit screen.
Cursor
at Last
name
Tap New
7-4
Applications: Address Book
3. Enter the last name of the person you want to add to your Address Book.
Note: Your SPT 1800 terminal automatically capitalizes the first letter of
each field (except numeric and e-mail fields). You do not have to use
the Graffiti capital stroke to capitalize the first letter of the name.
4. Tap the Last Name selected field.
5. Enter the person's information in that field.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to enter the other information that you want to include in this
Address Book entry.
7. Tap the
arrows to move to the next page of information.
8. After you finish entering information, tap the Done button to return to the Address
List screen.
Note: You can also attach a note to an entry simply by tapping Note and
entering the necessary information.
Tap Done
Tip: You can create an Address Book entry that always displays at the top of the
list by beginning the Last name (or Company name) field with a blank space. For
example, you might create an “If Found Call” entry that contains your name and
phone number in case you lose your SPT 1800 terminal.
7-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Deleting an Address Book Entry
Use the Menu Commands (described in Record Menu on page 7-12) or the Address Entry
Details screen to delete an entry.
To delete an entry with the Address Entry Details screen:
1. Tap the Address Book entry that you want to delete to display the Address View
screen for that entry.
2. Tap the Edit button to display the Address Edit screen.
3. Tap the Details button to open the Event Details screen.
4. Tap the Delete button to open the Delete Address alert.
5. Tap the OK button to confirm you want to delete the entry.
Duplicating an Address Book Entry
You can duplicate existing entries, which can be helpful when you want to enter multiple
people from a single organization. When you duplicate an entry, the word Copy displays
next to the name in the First Name field.
To duplicate an entry:
1. Tap the name you want to duplicate.
2. Perform one of the following:
•
Tap the Address Edit tab at the top of the screen; then tap Duplicate Record in
the Record menu.
•
In the Graffiti text area of your device’s screen, drag a diagonal line from the
lower left to upper right to display the Command toolbar; then write a T in the
Graffiti text area to initiate the Duplicate Record command.
3. Edit the record as necessary.
Working with Address Book Entries
Your SPT 1800 terminal enables you to quickly find your Address Book entries, group them
by category, and display the entries by name or company name. You can also choose the
type of information you want your entries to include and exchange Address Book
information with other SPT 1800 terminal users.
7-6
Applications: Address Book
Looking Up Address Book Entries
When working with the Address Book, the scroll button on the front panel of the SPT 1800
terminal makes it easy to navigate among your address entries. In the Address List screen,
the scroll button moves up or down an entire screen of address entries. If you hold down
the scroll button, you accelerate the scrolling so that it displays every third screen. In the
Address View screen, the scroll button moves to the previous or next address entry.
You can also use the Address List Look Up feature to quickly scroll to any of your Address
Book entries.
To look up an Address Book entry:
1. Display the Address List screen.
2. Enter the first letter of the name you want to find.
Look Up line
Note: The letter displays on the Look Up line and the list scrolls to the first
entry that begins with that letter. If you write another letter, the list
scrolls to the first entry that starts with those two letters. For
example, writing an “s” might scroll to “Sands,” and writing “sm”
might scroll further to “Smith.” If you sort the list by company name,
the Look Up feature scrolls to the first letter of the company name.
3. Tap any entry to view its contents, or use the carriage return stroke to view the
selected entry.
Choosing Types of Phone Numbers
Your SPT 1800 terminal enables you to choose the types of phone numbers or e-mail
addresses that you associate with an Address Book entry. Any changes you make apply
only to the current Address Book entry.
7-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To choose other types of phone numbers in an Address Book entry:
1. Tap the Address Book entry.
2. Tap the Edit button to display the Address Edit screen for that entry.
3. Tap the pick list next to the label you want to change.
Tap triangle
4. Tap the new label you want to use.
Assigning Address Categories
Categories can help you file individual Address Book entries into groups for easy review.
You can assign and edit categories in the Address Book or by using the Categories pick list
in the Details screen (Refer to Using Categories on page 3-22 for a complete description of
categories).
To assign a category to an Address Book entry:
1. Tap the Address Book entry you want to assign to a category.
2. Tap the Edit button in the Address View screen to display the Address Edit screen.
3. Tap the pick list in the upper-right corner and tap the category that you want to
assign to the Address Book entry.
Sorting by Name or Company
You can sort the entries in the Address List screen by Company and Last Name, rather than
by Last Name and First Name. These settings do not change your Address Book data; they
merely change the view.
7-8
Applications: Address Book
To sort the entries in the Address List screen:
1. Display the Address List screen.
2. Tap the
icon to open the Address Book menus.
3. Tap Preferences from the Options menu to open the Address Book Preferences
screen.
4. Tap the setting that you want for the Address List screen.
5. Tap the OK button to display the Address List screen with your new setting.
Note: Entries with no company name sort by last name.
Editing Address Entry Details
The Address Entry Details screen provides a variety of options that you can associate with
an Address entry.
To open the Address Entry Details screen:
1. Tap an Address Book entry to display the Address View screen for that entry.
2. Tap the Edit button to display the Address Edit screen.
3. Tap the Details button to open the Address Entry Details screen.
7-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
4. Select any of the following settings:
Show in List Choose which type of phone or other information displays on the
Address List screen for the current entry. Your options are: Work,
Home, Fax, Other and E-mail.
Category
Assign the entry to a particular category. Your options are:
Business, Personal, QuickList, Unfiled and Edit Categories.
Private
Hide this entry when the security features are turned on.
Beaming Address Entries to Other SPT 1800 Terminals
The IR port on your SPT 1800 terminal enables you to beam the following Address Book
entries to other SPT 1800 terminals:
•
Business card. A specially designated entry containing information you want to
exchange with business contacts. You can send your business card quickly with
one-touch beaming.
•
Current address entry. The entry currently selected on your SPT 1800 terminal.
For example, you may want to beam the name of a business contact to a coworker
who also uses an SPT 1800 terminal.
•
Category of address entries. All entries assigned to the selected category. For
example, you might want to share your list of restaurants with a friend.
Note: For more on the IR port, refer to Beaming Information to Other SPT
1800 Terminals on page 3-27.
To select a business card:
1. Create an Address Book entry containing the information you want on your
business card.
2. Tap your business card entry to display the Address View screen for that entry.
3. Tap the
icon to open the Address Book menus.
4. Tap Select Business Card from the Record menu, and tap Yes to accept this entry
as your business card.
To beam a business card:
1. Tap your business card entry to display the Address View screen for that entry.
7-10
Applications: Address Book
2. Tap the
icon to open the Address Book menus.
3. Tap Beam Business Card from the Record menu to beam your card to another SPT
1800 terminal.
Tip: You can press the
button for about two seconds to beam your card.
To beam the current entry:
1. Tap an Address Book entry that you want to beam to display the Address View
screen for that entry.
2. Tap the
icon to open the Address Book menus.
3. Tap Beam Address from the Record menu to beam the current entry to another
SPT 1800 terminal through the IR port.
Tip: You can set the full-screen pen stroke to beam the current entry. Refer to Pen
Preferences on page 13-5 for details.
To beam the current category:
1. Display the Address List screen.
2. Tap the pick list in the upper-right corner and tap the category you want to beam to
display the entries in that category.
3. Tap the
icon to open the Address Book menus.
4. Tap Beam Category from the Record menu to beam the entries in the current
category to another SPT 1800 terminal through the IR port.
Address Book Menu Commands
The Address Book includes menu commands to make it fast and easy to perform common
file and editing tasks. This section explains the menu commands specific to the Address
Book.
Refer to Using Menus on page 3-18 for information about menu commands common to all
of your SPT 1800 terminal applications.
7-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Record Menu
When you select the Record menu, its commands display on the screen. The menu
commands are slightly different depending on the current screen.
Address List
Address View
Delete Address Opens an alert screen prompting you to confirm deletion of the current
entry. Tap the OK button to delete the entry from your SPT 1800
terminal, or tap the Cancel button to close the alert screen and keep the
entry.
Note: By default, your SPT 1800 terminal removes the entry from the
Address Book, but retains a copy of the entry and transfers it to an
archive file on your computer the next time you perform a HotSync
operation. To remove the entry completely, clear the Save archive copy
on PC check box.
Attach Note
Opens the Address Book Note screen where you can create a Note for
the current entry.
Delete Note
Opens an alert screen prompting you to confirm deletion of the Note
attached to the entry. Tap the OK button to delete the Note, or tap the
Cancel button to close the alert screen and keep the note.
Beam Address
Beams the current Address Book entry to another SPT 1800 terminal
through the IR port.
Beam Category Beams all Address Book entries in the current category to another SPT
1800 terminal through the IR port.
Select Business Enables you to select the current Address Book entry as your business
Card
card. To beam your business card to other SPT 1800 terminals, use the
Beam Business Card command.
Beam Business Sends the current business card to another SPT 1800 terminal through
Card
the IR port. You can also initiate this command by holding down the
Address Book button for at least two seconds. This is a convenient way
to exchange business cards with other SPT 1800 terminal users.
7-12
Applications: Address Book
Options Menu
When you select the Options menu, its commands display on screen:
Address View
Address List
Font
Opens the Select Font screen where you can choose a different
font (text) style for your Address Book entries. Refer to
Choosing Fonts on page 3-20 for details.
Preferences
Opens the Address Book Preferences screen.
•
Remember last category. Determines how the
Address Book displays when you return from another
Palm application (Memo Pad, To Do List, etc.). If you
select this check box, the Address Book shows the last
category you selected. When you clear it, the Address
Book shows the address entries for all categories.
•
List By. Determines whether address entries sort by
last name, first name or by company name, last name
in the Address List screen.
7-13
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Rename
Custom Fields
Enables you to define custom field names. Each Address Book
entry contains four “custom fields” that you can rename. Any
changes you make to the names of the custom fields display in
all of your Address Book entries.
About Address Shows version (revision) information for the Address Book
Book
application.
7-14
Chapter 8
Applications: Memo Pad
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Opening the Memo Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Creating a New Memo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reviewing Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Arranging Memos. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Manually Arranging the Memo List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Choosing a Memo Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Marking a Private Memo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deleting a Memo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memo Pad Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Record Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-3
8-3
8-4
8-5
8-5
8-6
8-6
8-6
8-7
8-8
8-8
8-9
8-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
8-2
Applications: Memo Pad
Introduction
The Memo Pad provides a place to take notes that are not associated with Date Book,
Address Book or To Do items.
With the Memo Pad, you can:
•
Take notes or write any kind of message on your SPT 1800 terminal.
•
Drag and drop memos into popular computer applications like Microsoft Word,
when you synchronize using Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software and
HotSync technology.
•
Assign categories for memos. This enables you to quickly view your businessrelated memos, personal memos or any other category that you define.
•
Quickly jot down phone numbers and other types of information. Later, you can
copy and paste this information to other applications.
Opening the Memo Pad
To open the Memo Pad:
1. Press the Memo Pad button on the front panel of the SPT 1800 terminal to display
the Memo List screen.
Memo Pad button
Tip: Press the Memo Pad button repeatedly to cycle through the categories in
which you have memos.
8-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Creating a New Memo
A memo is the record where you enter, review and modify the individual Memo Pad entries.
A memo can contain up to 4,000 characters; the number of memos you can store is
dependent only on the memory available on your SPT 1800 terminal.
To create a new memo:
1. Open the Memo Pad application.
2. Tap the New button to create a new memo.
Tap New
Note: In the Memo List screen, you can also begin writing in the Graffiti 2
writing area to create a new memo. The first letter is automatically
capitalized and begins your new memo.
3. Enter the text you want to appear in the memo. Use the carriage return stroke to
move down to new lines in the memo.
4. After you finish, tap the Done button to return to the Memo List screen.
8-4
Applications: Memo Pad
Reviewing Memos
Each time you create a memo, the first line of the memo displays in the Memo List screen.
This makes it easy to locate and review your memos.
To review the contents of a memo:
1. Tap the text of the memo that appears in the Memo List screen to display the memo
on the screen.
Tap a
memo to
review its
contents
2. Review or edit the text in the memo. If the message is more than one page, a scroll
bar will display for easy navigation. If the message is longer than one page, use the
Options menu items to navigate.
3. Tap the Done button to save your changes to the memo and return to the Memo
List screen.
Arranging Memos
The Memo Preferences screen enables you to sort your memos alphabetically or in any
order that you want.
To select a sort option:
1. In the Memo List screen, tap the
icon to open the Memo Pad menus.
2. Tap Preferences from the Options menu to open the Memo Preferences screen.
8-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
3. Tap the Sort by pick list and choose Manual or Alphabetic.
4. Tap the OK button to close the Memo Preferences screen and activate your setting.
Manually Arranging the Memo List
If you choose the Manual option for the Sort by setting, you can rearrange the order of the
memos in the Memo List screen. Your SPT 1800 terminal renumbers all the memos to
reflect the new order.
Note: The Manual setting of the Memo Preferences is not transferred to
the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop. If you choose to display your
memos alphabetically on the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop and
then perform a HotSync operation, the memos are still arranged in
the order defined in the Memo Preferences setting.
To rearrange the order of your memos:
1. Select the Manual option in the Preferences screen as described in the previous
procedure.
2. In the Memo List screen, tap and drag the memo to a new location in the list. When
you lift the stylus from the SPT 1800 terminal screen, the memo displays in its new
location.
Choosing a Memo Category
Categories are used to file individual memos into groups for easy review. You can assign
and edit categories using the Categories pick list (in the upper-right corner of the screen)
or the Details screen. Refer to Using Categories on page 3-22 for a complete description
of categories.
Marking a Private Memo
You can designate a specific memo as “private.” When you activate the Security features,
your SPT 1800 terminal hides all private entries and you must enter a password to display
them on the screen.
8-6
Applications: Memo Pad
To mark a memo as private:
1. Tap the memo you want to mark as private to display it on the screen.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Memo Details screen for that memo.
3. Select the Private check box.
4. Tap the OK button to close the Memo Details screen and return to the memo
screen.
Deleting a Memo
There are three ways to delete a memo: simply delete the text of the memo, use the Menu
Command (as described in the Record Menu on page 8-8) or use the Memo Details screen.
To delete a memo with the Memo Details screen:
1. Tap the memo that you want to delete to display it on the screen.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Memo Details screen.
3. Tap the Delete button to open the Delete Memo alert.
4. Tap the OK button to confirm that you want to delete the current memo.
8-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Memo Pad Menu Commands
The Memo Pad includes menu commands to make it fast and easy to perform common file
and editing tasks. Refer to Using Menus on page 3-18 for information about menu
commands that are common to all SPT 1800 terminal applications.
Record Menu
When you select the Record menu, its commands display on screen:
Record Menu when viewing
Memo List
Record Menu when viewing
the Memo screen
Beam Category Beams all memos in the current category to another terminal through
the IR port.
New Memo
Creates a new memo.
Delete Memo
Opens an alert screen, prompting you to confirm that you want to
delete the current memo. Tap the OK button to delete the memo from
your SPT 1800 terminal, or tap the Cancel button to close the alert
screen and keep the memo.
Note:By default your SPT 1800 terminal removes the memo from the
Memo List, but retains a copy of the memo and transfers it to an
archive file on your computer the next time you perform a HotSync
operation. To remove the memo completely, clear the Save archive
copy on PC check box.
Beam Memo
8-8
Beams the current memo to another SPT 1800 terminal through the IR
port.
Applications: Memo Pad
Options Menu
When you select the Options menu, its commands display on screen.
Options Menu when
viewing Memo List
Options menu when
viewing the Memo Screen
Font
Opens the Select Font screen where you can choose a different
font (text) style for your Memo Pad entries. Refer to Choosing
Fonts on page 3-20 for details.
Preferences
Activates the Memo Preferences screen and enables you to define
the sort order for your memos.
Security
Opens the Change Security screen where you can change the
security of the open memo. Refer to Chapter 14, Applications:
Security for details.
Phone Lookup
Activates the Phone Lookup feature, described in Using Phone
Lookup on page 4-4.
About Memo Pad
Shows version (revision) information for the Memo Pad
application.
8-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
8-10
Chapter 9
Applications: To Do List
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Opening the To Do List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Working With To Do Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Setting Priority (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Checking Off a To Do Item . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
To Do Item Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
Choosing a To Do Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Setting a Due Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Marking a To Do Item Private . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Deleting a To Do Item. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
To Do Show Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
To Do List Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Record Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11
9-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
9-2
Applications: To Do List
Introduction
The To Do List is a convenient place to create reminders and prioritize the activities that
you have to do.
With the To Do List, you can:
•
Make a quick and convenient list of things to do.
•
Assign a priority level to each task.
•
Assign a due date for any or all of your To Do items.
•
Assign a category for any, or all of your To Do items. You can then view your To Do
List based on category (Business, Personal, etc.).
•
Sort your To Do items by due date, priority level or category.
•
Attach notes to individual To Do items for a description or clarification of the task.
Opening the To Do List
Press the To Do List button on the front panel of the SPT 1800 terminal to display the To
Do List screen.
To Do List button
Tip: Press the To Do List button repeatedly to cycle through the categories in which
you have items.
9-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Working With To Do Items
A To Do item is a reminder of some task that you have to complete. Your SPT 1800 terminal
gives you control over the appearance, level of detail and the sort order of To Do items.
To create a To Do item:
1. Tap the New button in the To Do List screen.
New To
Do item
Tap New
2. Enter the text you want to appear in the To Do item. The text can be longer than
one line.
Note: If a To Do item is not currently selected, writing in the Graffiti 2 writing
area automatically creates a new To Do item.
3. Tap anywhere on the screen to de-select the To Do item.
Note: You can add a name, address, and phone number to a To Do List
item using the Phone Lookup option. Refer to Using Phone Lookup
on page 4-4 for details.
Setting Priority (Optional)
Priority settings for To Do items enable you to arrange the tasks in your To Do List according
to relative levels of importance. The default setting for the To Do List arranges To Do items
by priority and due date, with priority 1 items at the top. If you have a number of To Do items
in your list, changing an item’s priority setting may move its position in the list.
9-4
Applications: To Do List
Note: When you create a new To Do item, its Priority is automatically set
to level “1,” the highest (most important) level. However, if you select
a To Do item first, the new item displays beneath the selected item
with the same priority as the selected item.
To set a Priority level for a To Do item:
1. Tap the Priority number on the left side of the To Do item to open the Priority pick
list. (Refer to To Do Show Options on page 9-8 if priority numbers are not visible.)
Tap here
Tap to
select
priority
2. Tap the Priority number that you want to set for the To Do item (1 is most important
and 5 is least important).
Note: You can also change the Priority setting for a To Do item with the To
Do Details screen described later in this chapter.
Checking Off a To Do Item
The To Do List makes it easy to mark tasks as you complete them. You can set the To Do
List to record the date that you complete the To Do item and you can choose to show or
hide complete To Do items. Refer to To Do Show Options on page 9-8.
To check off a To Do List item:
1. In the To Do List, select an entry and tap the Show button.
2. In the To Do Preferences screen, tap Show Completed Items.
9-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: If you clear this setting, your To Do items disappear from the list
when you complete (check) them. These items have not been
deleted, and still reside in the memory of your SPT 1800 terminal.
You must purge completed items to remove them from memory.
Refer to To Do Show Options on page -8 for details.
3. Tap the check box on the left side of the item.
Completed To
Do item
To Do Item Details
The To Do Item Details screen enables you to change individual To Do item settings.
To activate the To Do Item Details screen:
1. Tap anywhere on the text of a To Do item in the To Do List screen.
2. Tap the Details button to open the To Do Item Details screen.
The following sections describe the features and settings that are available in the To Do
Item Details screen.
9-6
Applications: To Do List
Choosing a To Do Category
Categories can help you file individual To Do items into groups for easy review. You can
assign and edit categories using the Categories pick list in the Details screen (refer to Using
Categories on page 3-22 for a complete description of categories).
Setting a Due Date
You can associate a due date with any To Do List item. You can also sort the items that
display in the list based on their due date.
To set a Due Date for a To Do List Item:
1. Tap the “No Date” text in the Details screen to open the Due Date pick list.
Tap here to view
the Due Date pick list
2. Tap the Due Date pick list to view potential due dates for the To Do item. The
following are available:
Today
Assigns the current date.
Tomorrow
Assigns tomorrow’s date.
One week later
Assigns the date exactly one week from the current date.
No Date
Removes the due date from the To Do item.
Choose date
Opens the Due Date screen where you can chose any due
date that you want for the To Do item.
3. Tap the OK button to confirm your selection and close the To Do Details screen.
Note: If you turn on the Show Due Dates option in the To Do Show options
screen, you can tap directly on the due date in the To Do List to open
the pick list shown in step 2.
9-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Marking a To Do Item Private
An item on your To Do List can be marked as Private by tapping the Private checkbox. Note
it can only be Private if Security is turned on.
Deleting a To Do Item
There are three ways to delete a To Do item: simply delete the text of the To Do item, use
the Menu Command (as described in Record Menu on page 9-10), or use the To Do Details
screen.
To delete a To Do item with the To Do Details screen:
1. Tap anywhere in the text area of the To Do item that you want to delete.
2. Tap the Details button to open the To Do Item Details screen.
3. Tap the Delete button to open the Delete To Do alert screen.
4. Tap the OK button to confirm that you want to delete the To Do item.
To Do Show Options
The Show Options screen enables you to control the appearance of the To Do List
application.
To change the Show Options settings:
1. Tap the Show button in the To Do List screen to open the To Do Preferences
screen.
9-8
Applications: To Do List
2. Select any of the following settings:
Sort by
Show
Completed
Items
Enables you to sort the To Do items in one of the following
ways:
• Priority, Due Date
•
Due Date, Priority
•
Category, Priority
•
Category, Due Date
Displays your complete To Do items in the To Do List. If you
turn off this setting, your To Do items disappear from the list
when you complete (check) them. They will remain in memory
until they are Purged (refer to Record Menu on page 9-10 for
more information about purging).
Show Only Due Shows only the To Do items that are currently due, past due or
Items
have no due date specified in the To Do List. When this setting
is active, To Do items that are not yet due do not display.
Record
Completion
Date
Replaces the due date with the actual completion date (when
you checked the item). If you do not assign a due date to an
item, the completion date still records when you complete the
item.
Show Due Dates Displays the due dates associated with To Do items in the To
Do List screen, and displays an exclamation mark next to
incomplete To Do items after the due date passes.
Show Priorities Shows the priority numbers for the To Do items in the To Do List
screen.
Show
Categories
Shows the category for each To Do item on the far right of the
To Do List screen.
3. Tap the OK button to confirm your selections and close the screen.
9-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To Do List Menu Commands
The To Do List includes menu commands to perform common file and editing tasks. Refer
to Using Menus on page 3-18 for information about menu commands that are common to
all SPT 1800 terminal applications.
Record Menu
When you select the Record menu, its commands display on screen.
Delete Item
Opens an alert screen, prompting you to confirm that you want to delete
the current To Do item. You must select a To Do item before you can
delete it. Tap the OK button to delete the To Do item from your SPT
1800 terminal, or tap the Cancel button to close the alert screen and
keep the To Do item.
Note: By default your SPT 1800 terminal removes the item from the To
Do list, but retains a copy of the item and transfers it to an archive file
on your computer the next time you perform a HotSync operation. To
remove the event completely, clear the Save archive copy on PC check
box.
Attach Note
Opens the To Do Note screen where you can create a note for the
current To Do item.
Delete Note
Opens an alert screen, prompting you to confirm that you really want to
delete the note attached to the To Do item. You must select a To Do item
before you can delete its note. Tap the Yes button to delete the Note
from the memory of your SPT 1800 terminal, or tap the No button to
close the alert screen and return to the To Do List.
9-10
Applications: To Do List
Purge
Deletes To Do items that you mark (check) as complete. All complete
To Do List items remain in the To Do List until you use this command.
The default setting is “Save archive copy on PC.” This removes
complete To Do items from the To Do List, but retains copies and
transfers them to an archive file on your computer the next time you
perform a HotSync operation.
Beam Item
Beams the current To Do item to another SPT 1800 terminal through
the IR port.
Beam Category Beams all To Do Items in the current category to another SPT 1800
terminal through the IR port.
Options Menu
When you select the Options menu, its commands displays on screen.
Font
Displays the Select Font screen where you can choose a different font
(text) style for your Address Book entries. Refer to Choosing Fonts on
page 3-20 for details.
Phone Lookup
Activates the Phone Lookup feature, which is described in Using
Phone Lookup on page 4-4.
Security
Allows you to change the Security on a To Do List item. You can hide,
show, or mask an item. Refer to Chapter 14, Applications: Security for
details.
About To Do
List
Shows version (revision) information for the To Do List application.
9-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
9-12
Chapter 10
Applications: HotSync®
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
The HotSync Process and the HotSync Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Performing a HotSync Operation for the First Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Using User Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
Using File Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
Conducting a Local HotSync Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Selecting HotSync Setup Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Customizing HotSync Application Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
Conducting a HotSync Operation via Modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Preparing Your Computer for a Modem HotSync Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Preparing Your SPT 1800 Terminal for a Modem HotSync Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15
Selecting the Conduits for a Modem HotSync Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16
Performing a HotSync Operation via Modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
Conducting Wireless HotSync Operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Setting Up for a Wireless HotSync. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Performing a Spectrum24 HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
Performing a CDPD HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20
Performing a GSM HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
Setting Up the Ethernet Cradle for HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22
Installing NetSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22
Creating a CRD1700-4000E Modem Sync Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Configuring the Remote Host PC for Use with the Ethernet Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-24
The Ethernet HotSync Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-24
10-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
10-2
Applications: HotSync®
Introduction
HotSync technology enables you to synchronize (exchange and update) data between one
or more SPT 1800 terminals and the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software. To
synchronize data, you must connect your SPT 1800 terminal and Symbol Palm Terminal
Desktop either directly with a cable or cradle, or indirectly with a modem or network.
With HotSync technology you can:
•
Synchronize the data entries on your SPT 1800 terminal with the entries on your
host system, and vice versa.
•
Manage individual or multiple SPT 1800 terminals with a centralized computer.
•
Keep your data safe by automatically creating backup copies each time you
synchronize.
The HotSync Process and the HotSync Manager
The HotSync process automatically synchronizes data between your SPT 1800 terminal
and Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop. Changes you make on your SPT 1800 terminal or
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop display in both places after a HotSync operation. HotSync
technology synchronizes only the needed portions of files, thus reducing synchronization
time. You can synchronize your data by connecting your SPT 1800 terminal directly to your
computer with either the single- or four-slot serial cradle or Synchronization/Charging
Cable, or indirectly with a modem or network.
The HotSync Manager oversees the synchronization process. It runs in the background
and monitors a communications port on your computer for a HotSync command from an
SPT 1800 terminal. When it “hears” a HotSync command, HotSync Manager synchronizes
data in the Date Book, Address Book, To Do List and Memo Pad applications, even when
the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop is not running!
Once you complete a few simple setup steps, performing a HotSync operation is as simple
as pressing a button. Follow the steps in the next section to complete the setup.
Performing a HotSync Operation for the First Time
The first time you synchronize your data, you need to enter user information on both the
SPT 1800 terminal and the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop. Once you enter this information
and synchronize, the HotSync Manager recognizes your SPT 1800 terminal and doesn’t
ask for this information again. If you are a System Administrator preparing several SPT
10-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
1800 terminals for a group of users, refer to Conducting Wireless HotSync Operations on
page 10-18 performing the following steps.
Important: You must perform your first HotSync operation with a local, direct connection,
rather than using a modem.
Note: The following instructions assume that you have already installed
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software on your computer. If you
have not yet installed the software, refer to Symbol Palm Terminal
Desktop Software on page 1-29 for details.
To perform a HotSync operation for the first time:
1. Double-click the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop icon on the Windows desktop (or
select Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop from the Start menu) to start the Symbol
Palm Terminal Desktop software.
2. Click the
menu.
icon in the Windows System Tray to open the HotSync Manager
Tip: The Windows System Tray is usually in the lower-right corner on your
computer display. The location may vary depending on the location of the taskbar
and the version of Windows you are using.
3. Click Local from the HotSync Manager menu to indicate that you are using the
cradle or the synchronization/charging cable to synchronize.
4. Turn on the SPT 1800 terminal and slide it into the cradle.
10-4
Applications: HotSync®
Note: If you are using the synchronization/charging cable, connect one
end of the cable into the serial port on the back of your computer,
and the other end into the serial port on the bottom of the terminal.
Tip: The curved edge on the bottom of the SPT 1800 terminal should align
smoothly with the cradle when it is inserted properly.
5. Press the
dialog.
button on the front of the SPT 1800 cradle and open the New User
Note: If you are using the synchronization/charging cable, tap the
on the terminal.
icon
10-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
HotSync
button
6. Enter a user name for your SPT 1800 terminal and click the OK button to open the
HotSync Progress dialog and start the synchronization process.
Important: Every SPT 1800 terminal should have a unique name. Never try to
synchronize more than one SPT 1800 terminal to the same user name.
7. Wait for the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop to display a message indicating that
the process is complete.
Using User Profiles
If you need to configure a number of SPT 1800 terminals with specific information (such as
a company phone list) before distributing them to their users, you can create a User Profile
to load the data into a SPT 1800 terminal without associating that data with a user name.
The User Profile feature is designed only for the first-time HotSync operation, before you
assign a User ID to a particular SPT 1800 terminal. Refer to Conducting Wireless HotSync
Operations on page 10-18 for information about loading data after you assign a User ID.
10-6
Applications: HotSync®
To create a User Profile:
1. Open the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software.
2. Click Users from the Tools menu to open the Users dialog.
3. Click the Profiles button to open the Profiles dialog.
4. Click the New button to open the New Profile dialog.
5. Enter a unique name for the Profile and click the OK button to return to the Profiles
dialog.
6. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for each Profile that you want to create, then click the OK
button to return to the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop.
7. Select the Profile from the User drop-down box in the upper right hand corner of
the screen and create the data for the Profile (e.g., company phone list, etc.).
10-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To use a Profile for the first-time HotSync operation:
1. Place the new SPT 1800 terminal in the cradle, and press the
cradle to open the Users dialog.
button on the
2. Click the Profiles button to open the Profiles dialog.
3. Choose the Profile that you want to load on the SPT 1800 terminal, and click the
OK button to open the following alert dialog:
4. Click the Yes button to transfer all the Profile data to the SPT 1800 terminal.
The next time you perform a HotSync operation, the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
prompts you to assign a User name to the SPT 1800 terminal.
Using File Link
The File Link feature enables you to synchronize the Address Book and Memo Pad
information on your SPT 1800 terminal with a separate external file such as a company
phone list. HotSync Manager stores the data in a separate category on your Symbol Palm
Terminal Desktop and your SPT 1800 terminal. You can configure the File Link feature to
check for changes to the external file when you perform a HotSync operation.
With File Link you can synchronize with data stored in any of the following formats:
•
Comma delimited (*.csv)
•
Tab delimited (*.tsv)
•
Memo Pad archive (*.mpa)
•
Address Book archive (*.aba)
•
Text (*.txt)
For information on how to set up a File Link, refer to the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
Software online Help.
10-8
Applications: HotSync®
Conducting a Local HotSync Operation
After you complete the first HotSync operation, the HotSync process is even faster and
easier!
To conduct a local HotSync operation:
1. Insert the SPT 1800 terminal in the cradle, or connect the Synchronization/
Charging cable.
2. Start the HotSync Manager.
3. Press the
button on the front of the CRD1800-1000S cradle to start the
HotSync process. If you are using the Synchronization/Charging cable or the CRD
1700-4000S cradle, tap the
icon on the terminal’s application screen.
Synchronization begins immediately.
4. Wait for the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop to display a message indicating that
the process is complete.
Selecting HotSync Setup Options
You can choose when you want HotSync Manager to run, and adjust the local, modem, and
network HotSync settings.
To set the HotSync Options:
1. Click the
icon in the Windows System Tray to open the HotSync Manager menu
and click Setup. The Setup dialog displays with the General tab open:
.
10-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
2. Select one of the following options:
Always available
Adds HotSync Manager to the Startup folder and
constantly monitors the communication port for SPT
1800 terminal synchronization requests. With this
option, the HotSync Manager conducts
synchronizations even when the Symbol Palm
Terminal Desktop is not running.
Available only when the Starts HotSync Manager and monitors requests
Symbol Palm Terminal automatically when you open the Symbol Palm
Desktop is running
Terminal Desktop software.
Manual
Starts the HotSync Manager and monitors requests
only when you select HotSync Manager from the Start
menu.
Tip: If you’re not sure which option to use, use the Always available default setting.
3. Click the Local tab to display the settings for the connection between your
computer and the SPT 1800 cradle or synchronization cable, and adjust the
options as needed.
Serial Port
10-10
Identifies the port Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop will use to
communicate with the cradle or the synchronization/charging
cable. This selection should match the port number where you
connected the cradle or synchronization/charging cable.
Note: Your SPT 1800 terminal cannot share this port with an
internal modem or other device. If you have trouble determining
the correct serial port, refer to Troubleshooting on page 17-9.
Applications: HotSync®
Speed
Determines the speed at which data is transferred between
your SPT 1800 terminal and Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop.
We suggest you try the As Fast As Possible rate first, and
adjust downward if you experience problems. This setting
allows the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop and SPT 1800
terminal to find and use the fastest speed.
4. Click the Modem tab to display the Modem settings and adjust the options as
needed.
Serial Port
Identifies the port where the modem is located. If you are
unsure of the port assignment, review the Modem Properties in
the Windows Control Panel.
Speed
Determines the speed at which data is transferred. We suggest
you try the As Fast As Possible rate first, and adjust downward
if you experience problems. This setting allows the Symbol
Palm Terminal Desktop and SPT 1800 terminal to find and use
the fastest speed.
Modem
Identifies the modem type or manufacturer. Refer to your
modem manual or face plate for its type or settings. If you’re not
sure of your modem type or your modem doesn’t match any
that appear in the list, choose Hayes Basic.
Setup String
Identifies the setup string for your particular modem. Not all
modems require a setup string. Refer to your modem manual
and enter the setup string if recommended by the
manufacturer.
10-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
5. Click the Network tab to display Network settings and adjust the options as needed.
Note: You must have Network HotSync software installed to use this
feature. Refer to Configuring NetSync Options on page 10-21.
6. Click TCP/IP Settings to obtain the Primary PC Name, Address, and Subnet Mask
(optional) for the selected user.
7. Click OK to close the Setup dialog.
Customizing HotSync Application Settings
For each application you can define a set of options that determines how records are
handled during synchronization. These options are called a “conduit.” By default, the
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop synchronizes all files between the SPT 1800 terminal and
the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop. In general, you should leave the settings to
synchronize all files. The only reason you might want to change these settings is to
overwrite data on either your SPT 1800 terminal or Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop, or to
avoid synchronizing a particular type of file because you don’t use it.
In addition to the standard application conduits, the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
includes System and Install conduits. The System conduit backs up the system information
stored in your SPT 1800 terminal, including Graffiti software ShortCuts. The Install conduit
is used to install Palm-compatible applications.
To customize HotSync application settings:
1. Click the
menu.
10-12
icon in the Windows System Tray to open the HotSync Manager
Applications: HotSync®
Tip: You can also click the HotSync command on the Symbol Palm Terminal
Desktop menu bar to open the HotSync Manager menu.
2. Click Custom from the HotSync menu to open the Custom dialog.
3. Select the appropriate user name from the drop-down list.
4. Select an application in the Conduit list to choose the conduit you want to change.
5. Click the Change button to open the Change HotSync Action dialog.
Check here to
make new settings
the default
Click to skip data
transfer for an
application
6. Determine the action you want to take.
Note: Changing the HotSync setting from the default affects only the next
HotSync operation. Thereafter, the HotSync Actions revert to their
default settings. To use a new setting on an ongoing basis, check the
Set As Default box. Clicking the Default button in the Custom dialog
will revert to the new default settings.
10-13
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
7. Repeat steps 2 through 6 to change conduit settings for other applications or for a
different user name.
8. Click the OK button to close the Change HotSync Action dialog and activate your
settings.
Conducting a HotSync Operation via Modem
You can use a modem to synchronize your SPT 1800 terminal when you are away from
your computer.
Note: You must first conduct an initial local HotSync operation using any
of the SPT 1800 cradles before you perform a modem HotSync
operation. Refer to Conducting a Local HotSync Operation on page
10-9 for details.
To perform a HotSync operation via modem you need:
•
A modem connected to your computer.
•
A modem connected to your SPT 1800 terminal with a special modem cable. (The
cradle is not used for a modem HotSync operation.)
•
The Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software configured for use with a modem as
described in Selecting HotSync Setup Options on page 10-9.
Preparing Your Computer for a Modem HotSync Operation
There are several steps you must perform to prepare your computer for a modem HotSync
operation. Be sure to perform these steps before you leave your office so that your
computer is ready to receive a call from your SPT 1800 terminal.
10-14
Applications: HotSync®
To prepare your computer for a modem HotSync operation:
1. Confirm that the computer modem is connected and turned on, and that no
communications applications, such as fax or telephony software, are running on a
COM port.
Note: Make sure the computer is disconnected from all online services,
such as America Online (AOL) and CompuServe. This helps to
avoid conflicts with the COM port.
2. Start HotSync Manager and select Modem from the HotSync Manager menu.
Refer to Selecting HotSync Setup Options on page 10-9 for details about this
screen.
Preparing Your SPT 1800 Terminal for a Modem HotSync
Operation
To prepare your SPT 1800 terminal for a modem HotSync operation:
1. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync screen.
3. Tap Modem and select your modem from the pick list.
Note: This will vary, dependent upon the SPT terminal you are using: SPT
1833 terminals use Merlin and SPT 184x terminals use Spectrum24.
4. Tap Enter Phone # to open the Phone Setup screen.
10-15
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: If you have Network HotSync software installed on your SPT 1800
terminal, the Remote Setup screen displays instead. Refer to
Network Preferences on page 13-14 for more information.
5. Enter the telephone number to access the modem connected to your computer.
6. If needed, enter a dial prefix (such as “9”) to access an outside line, and then tap
the Dial Prefix check box.
Tip: You can enter a comma in the field to introduce a “pause” in the dialing
sequence.
7. If the phone line you’re using for the SPT 1800 terminal has “Call Waiting,” select
the Disable call waiting check box to avoid an interruption during the modem
HotSync operation.
8. If you want to use a calling card to place the call, select the check box and enter
the calling card number.
9. Tap OK to return to the HotSync screen.
10. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync menus.
11. Tap Modem Sync Preferences from the Options menu to display the Modem Sync
Preferences screen.
12. Select Direct to Modem.
13. Click OK.
Selecting the Conduits for a Modem HotSync Operation
The Conduit Setup screen on your SPT 1800 terminal enables you to define which files
and/or applications synchronize during a modem HotSync operation. Use these settings to
minimize the time required to synchronize data with a modem.
To change the Conduit Setup for a modem HotSync operation:
1. Tap the
icon to display the HotSync screen.
2. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync menus.
3. Tap Conduit Setup from the Options menu to open the Conduit Setup screen.
10-16
Applications: HotSync®
4. Tap the check boxes to de-select the files and/or applications that you do not want
to synchronize during a modem HotSync operation. The default setting is to
synchronize all files.
Note: Applications that do not have a database (such as games) do not
synchronize — even if the item is selected in the Conduit Setup
screen.
5. Tap the OK button to close the Conduit Setup screen and activate your settings for
the next modem HotSync operation.
Performing a HotSync Operation via Modem
To perform a Modem HotSync operation:
Note: If you are not using a PalmPilot modem, you need a special modem
cable and an external modem. Connect one end of the special
modem cable to the serial connector on the SPT 1800 terminal and
the other end to the external modem. Do not attempt to use other
kinds of cables, even if they appear to be similar.
1. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync application.
2. Tap the large
icon to dial the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop modem and
synchronize the applications selected under Conduit Setup.
3. Wait for the HotSync operation to complete.
If you have any problems conducting a HotSync operation, refer to Troubleshooting
on page 17-9.
10-17
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Conducting Wireless HotSync Operations
Using HotSync you can take advantage of the LAN and WAN connectivity available in
business environments. You can dial in to a network or use a cradle that is connected to
any computer on your LAN or WAN (provided that the computer connected to the cradle
also has HotSync installed, your computer is on, and the HotSync Manager is running).
Setting Up for a Wireless HotSync
The SPT 1833 and 184x terminals allow you to perform a HotSync without using a cradle
over a terminal specific wireless LAN (184x) or WAN (178x). This section describes the
setup necessary for a wireless HotSync to occur.
Before a wireless HotSync can be performed, each terminal must be properly configured
for use. Refer to Chapter 2, Network Setup for specific instructions for each terminal.
Once the terminal is properly configured for use, it must be set up to perform a wireless
HotSync over the LAN or WAN.
To properly configure your terminal:
1. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync application.
3. Tap the
Prefs.
icon to display the HotSync Options menu and select Modem Sync
Select Network and tap OK.
4. Tap LANSync Prefs from the Options menu and select Local HotSync.
5. Tap Primary PC Setup on the Options menu.
Note: The Primary PC Setup is extremely important! It tells the terminal
how to locate the machine which it will synchronize with on the
network.
10-18
Applications: HotSync®
The Primary PC Setup screen displays:
The information required for this screen is located by selecting the TCP/IP button
on the Network tab of the HotSync Manager on the machine you are hotsyncing to.
Copy down the Primary PC Name, Primary PC address, and the Subnet mask, and
enter that information manually on the above screen. Refer to Selecting HotSync
Setup Options on page 10-9 for details on how to access the Network tab.
Note: If the Subnet Mask box on your PC is empty, you do not need to
enter anything in that section on your terminal.
6. Tap OK.
7. Tap Connection Setup on the Option menu and select:
a. Spectrum24 for a SPT 184x terminal
b. Merlin for a SPT 1833 (CDPD) terminal.
Performing a Spectrum24 HotSync
Note: This function is available on SPT 184x terminals only.
To perform a HotSync via the Spectrum24 wireless LAN:
1. Ensure the terminal has been properly configured for use. Refer to Setting Up for
a Wireless HotSync on page 10-18 for details.
2. Select the HotSync application from the main application screen.
3. Tap Modem, and tap Select Service to display the Network Preference Screen.
10-19
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
4. Verify that Spectrum24 displays in the Service pick list and that phone setup
information is accurate and tap Done.
5. Tap the HotSync button to initiate the HotSync.
Performing a CDPD HotSync
Note: This function is available on SPT 1833 terminals only.
To perform a HotSync via the CDPD wireless WAN:
1. Ensure the terminal has been properly configured for use. Refer to Setting Up for
a Wireless HotSync on page 10-18 for details.
2. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync application.
3. Tap Modem, and tap Select Service to display the Network Preference screen.
4. Verify that Merlin displays in the Service pick list and that phone setup information
is accurate and tap Done.
5. Tap the HotSync button to initiate the HotSync.
10-20
Applications: HotSync®
Setting Up the Ethernet Cradle for HotSync
When the SPT 1800 terminal is inserted into the CRD1700-4000E cradle, the cradle
appears as a dial-up PPP service to the terminal. Therefore, just as you would set up a
Palm III terminal to connect to an Internet Service Provider (ISP) like Compuserve or
Earthlink, the SPT 1800 terminals must be configured for use with the cradle. This section
describes the steps necessary to configure both the SPT 1800 terminal and the CRD17004000E.
Installing NetSync
An SPT 1800 terminal must have NetSync installed and configured for it to communicate
with the CRD1700-4000E. Additionally, NetSync extensions to the HotSync Manager must
be installed on the host system which the SPT 1800 terminal is to synchronize with. The
Network HotSync software is a free add-on for SPT 1800 terminals and is available at http:/
/www.palm.com/support/downloads/netsync.html.
Follow the instructions to install the network HotSync software on your host PC, then
perform a HotSync to install the program on your SPT 1800 terminal.
Configuring NetSync Options
Once NetSync is installed on your SPT 1800 terminal, it must be configured for use with the
CRD1700-4000E. From the HotSync panel on your SPT 1800, select each of the option
panels available from the “Options” menu (accessed by tapping the Menu icon) and
configure them as follows:
1. To configure Modem Sync Preferences:
2. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync menus.
3. Tap Modem Sync Preferences from the Options menu to display the Modem Sync
Preferences screen.
4. Select Network.
5. Tap OK.
6. To configure the Local Sync Preferences:
a. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync menus.
b. Tap LANSync Preferences from the Options menu to display the LANSync
Preferences screen.
c. Select Local HotSync (the CRD1700-4000E doesn’t use LANSync
functionality).
10-21
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
d. Tap OK.
7. To configure the Primary PC Setup, refer to the Setting Up for a Wireless HotSync
on page 10-18 for details:
Note: Primary PC Setup is extremely important! It tells the terminal how to
locate the machine which it will synchronize with on the network.
8. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync menus and select Conduit Setup.
a. Check any items that you want synchronized and uncheck any items that you
don’t want synchronized.
b. Tap OK.
9. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync menus and select Connection Setup.
a. For optimal performance, choose a communication rate of 57600 bps and a
Standard modem.
b. Tap Done.
Creating a CRD1700-4000E Modem Sync Service
The SPT 1800 terminal communicates with the CRD1700-4000E via a Modem Sync. The
Modem Sync offers many options which must be configured for use with the CRD17004000E.
Create a separate CRD1700-4000E network configuration and select it as your default
Modem Sync service. Use either Graffiti or the keyboard feature (click in the lower left-hand
corner of the scratch pad on the abc to access the keyboard) to enter the following
information:
1. Tap the
icon to open the HotSync application.
2. Choose the Select Service box under the Modem Sync icon to create a new
CRD1700-4000E service.
3. To select the Earthlink service, click Menu, Duplicate.
4. Change the service name to CRD1700-4000E. Leave the user name and
password blank. You may enter any phone number you want, except ‘00’, or you
may leave it blank. The SPT 1800 terminal will not be able to HotSync if you use
‘00’ as a phone number.
10-22
Applications: HotSync®
Configuring the Remote Host PC for Use with the Ethernet
Cradle
The remote PC you wish to HotSync the SPT 1800 to must be set up for Network HotSync
and configured to run from the network.
1. Make sure HotSync Manager is installed and running.
2. From the HotSync Manager, make sure Network is checked. If you don’t want
HotSync Manager to use a serial port, make sure Local is unchecked.
Note: The PC must be configured for proper TCP/IP network operation.
The Ethernet HotSync Process
Once the CRD1700-4000E is properly connected, data communication between an SPT
1800 terminal and the host computer can take place. When a terminal is inserted in the
cradle, the cradle detects its presence and attempts to initiate the HotSync process on the
terminal. All local slots in the cradle operate simultaneously; the HotSync procedure starts
immediately when any terminal is inserted into a local slot.
As stated earlier, if multiple slots are to be HotSync’d simultaneously, each must
communicate with a different host PC. If the application requires simultaneous connection
to a single host database, additional software, available from Symbol, is required.
Terminals inserted into daisy-chained cradles are HotSync’d in a round-robin fashion
simultaneously with any HotSyncs from local slots. Daisy-chained cradles share a logical
“fifth slot” on the CRD1700-4000E, which, while it shares equal priority with the local slots,
allows only one HotSync at a time.
Performing HotSync with the Ethernet Cradle
To initiate communication between the terminal and the host, gently insert the SPT 1800
terminal into a local cradle slot, or a slot on an inter-connected serial cradle. Do not force.
When properly inserted, the slot’s LED turns red, then changes to flashing green, indicating
that the host and the terminal are communicating. Removing the terminal from the cradle
while the LED is flashing green will result in a disruption of communication and data may
be lost.
If the terminal is inserted into an inter-connected serial cradle slot while another terminal on
the serial cradle chain is communicating with a host, the terminal waits (its LED remains
red) until the first terminal finishes communicating. After the communication session
10-23
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
completes, the slot’s LED turns solid green and remains green until the terminal is removed
from the slot. To remove the terminal, pull it straight up from the slot.
10-24
Chapter 11
Applications: ScoutSync Client
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overview of the ScoutSync Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring the ScoutSync Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Conduits for Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Performing a Synchronization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatically Synchronizing Using a Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing the Synchronization Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ScoutSync Client Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11-3
11-3
11-4
11-5
11-6
11-6
11-7
11-8
11-8
11-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
11-2
Applications: ScoutSync Client
Introduction
This chapter explains how to configure and use the ScoutSync Client on an SPT 1800
terminal. By reading this chapter, you will learn how to perform a synchronization and view
your ScoutSync Client synchronization log.
Note: Before performing the procedures found in this chapter, your system
administrator should install, set up, and run ScoutSync on a
computer. Your system administrator must also grant you access to
a Scout Server.
Overview of the ScoutSync Client
The ScoutSync Client is an application that enables you to connect your SPT 1800 terminal
to a Scout Server. A Scout Server resides on a Windows NT server or workstation that your
system administrator manages and is responsible for transferring data between the
ScoutSync Client and your company’s back-end applications and databases. Using Scout’s
powerful technology, you can seamlessly transfer data using an SPT 1800 terminal from
virtually anywhere to your company’s data stores.
Using the ScoutSync Client on your SPT 1800 terminal, you can:
•
Run ScoutSync Conduits
A ScoutSync Conduit is the central processing component that implements the
synchronization logic during a synchronization session. Your system administrator
installs conduits on your device.
•
Initiate a synchronization session
•
View your SPT 1800 terminal’s synchronization log.
11-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Configuring the ScoutSync Client
The Scout Preferences settings enable you to connect a mobile device to a ScoutSync
Server. When configuring the preferences, you must specify the Scout host/server name,
the command port used for ScoutSync Client/Server communications, and the user's
profile/ID.
Note: You must configure the settings before performing a
synchronization.
To configure the ScoutSync Client preferences of an SPT 1800 terminal:
1. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to open ScoutSync. The main ScoutSync screen displays:
3. Tap the Preferences button. The following screen displays:
4. Enter the Scout Server Name and the Port Number. The default connection port is
8025 and should not be changed unless instructed by your system administrator.
5. Enter the Profile.
11-4
Applications: ScoutSync Client
6. Tap the word “Unassigned” in the Password field to display the Password box. If
applicable, enter a password and tap the OK button. If not, tap Cancel.
Note: “Assigned” replaces “Unassigned” after you enter a password.
7. Tap the More button. The Advanced Preferences screen displays:
•
To synchronize on application launch, tap the Start sync on app launch check
box.
•
To close the network connection after a synchronization, tap the Close
connection after sync check box.
•
To be notified about errors, tap the Notify about errors during sync check box.
•
To indicate that you are using a Novatel Minstrel modem, tap the Check modem
status before sync check box.
8. Tap OK twice to close the Scout Preferences screen.
Selecting Conduits for Synchronization
Developers have the ability to create custom conduits for synchronizing data. Before
performing a synchronization, you can specify the conduits you want activated. Each
conduit is associated with an application and determines how data is handled during a
synchronization session. When a conduit is selected for synchronization, it knows what
actions to perform and how to process the files and databases.
To select conduits for synchronizing an SPT 1800 terminal:
1. Tap the
icon to open ScoutSync. The main ScoutSync screen displays.
2. Tap the
icon to open the Conduit List.
3. Tap the checkboxes of the conduits that you want to synchronize.
4. Tap Done.
11-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Performing a Synchronization
To perform a synchronization:
1. Tap the
icon from the Applications Launcher. The following screen displays:
2. Tap the
icon.
The synchronization process begins.
Automatically Synchronizing Using a Cradle
You can configure a mobile device to automatically start and connect to a server when
placed in the cradle. Once the device is configured, when placed in a cradle it will
automatically perform a synchronization until you disable the feature.
To automatically synchronize using a cradle with an SPT 1800 terminal:
1. Open the Applications Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon.
3. Tap the pick list in the upper-right corner and select Buttons. The following screen
displays:
11-6
Applications: ScoutSync Client
4. Tap the HotSync button to open HotSync. The following screen displays:
5. Select ScoutSync from the Cradle pick list.
6. Return to the Applications Launcher and tap the
screen is displayed.
icon. The main ScoutSync
7. Tap Preferences, then More. The Advanced Preferences screen displays:
8. Select the Start sync on app launch check box and tap OK.
9. Place the SPT 1800 terminal in the cradle.
Viewing the Synchronization Log
The synchronization log of a mobile device displays a record of the date and time a user
logged on and off a server. It also displays the list of files and databases installed on the
mobile device and other informational messages.
To view the Synchronization Log:
1. Tap the
icon. The main ScoutSync screen is displayed.
2. Tap the View Log button.
The ScoutSync Log is displayed.
Note: Only the most recent synchronization session log displays.
11-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
ScoutSync Client Menu Commands
ScoutSync Client includes menu commands to make it fast and easy to perform common
tasks. This section explains the menu commands specific to ScoutSync.
Refer to Using Menus on page 3-18 for information about menu commands common to
most of your SPT 1800 terminal applications.
Options Menu
When you select the Options menu, its commands display on the screen.
Conduit List
Allows you to choose which conduits run during ScoutSync.
ScoutSync
Automatically attempt a ScoutSync connection.
Preferences
Opens the Scout Preferences screen, where you can enter the Scout
Server name, port number, profile, and password.
Network
Settings
Opens the Preferences screen, where you set up your service and
connection preferences.
About
Provides version information.
11-8
Chapter 12
Applications: AirBEAM
Chapter Contents
Chapter Contents. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AirBEAM Package Builder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AirBEAM Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AirBEAM License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring the AirBEAM Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Synchronizing with the Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12-1
12-3
12-3
12-4
12-4
12-4
12-9
12-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
12-2
Applications: AirBEAM
Introduction
The AirBEAM product allows specially designed software packages to be transferred
between a host server and Symbol wireless handheld devices. Before transfer, AirBEAM
checks and compares package version, so that only updated packages are loaded.
AirBEAM resides on radio-equipped client devices, and allows them to request, download
and install software, as well as to upload files and status data. Both download and upload
of files can be accomplished in a single communications session. The ability to transfer
software over a radio network can greatly reduce the logistical efforts of client software
management.
In an AirBEAM system, a network-accessible host server acts as the storage point for the
software transfer. The AirBEAM client uses the industry standard FTP or TFTP file transfer
protocols to check the host system for updates, and if necessary, to transfer updated
software.
AirBEAM Package Builder
In a typical distributed AirBEAM system, software to be transferred is organized into
packages. In general, an AirBEAM package is simply a set of files that are assigned
attributes both as an entire package and as individual component files. The package is
assigned a version number, and the transfer occurs when an updated version is available.
An AirBEAM package can optionally contain developer-specified logic to be used to install
the package. Installation logic is typically used to update client device FLASH images or
radio firmware. Examples of common AirBEAM packages would include packages for
custom client application software, radio firmware and AirBEAM client software.
Once these packages are built, they are installed on the host server for retrieval by the
handheld device. The AirBEAM Package Builder is a utility used to define, generate and
install AirBEAM packages to a server. The packages are then loaded from the server onto
a client device equipped with an AirBEAM client executable.
For detailed instructions on how to define, generate and install AirBEAM packages to the
server, refer to the AirBEAM Package Builder Product Reference Guide, p/n 72-55769-xx,
available at www.symbol.com/manuals.
12-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
AirBEAM Client
The AirBEAM Client is installed on your handheld terminal. It needs to be configured with
the server access information, the names of the packages to be downloaded and other
controlling parameters. When the Client is launched, the device connects to the specified
FTP server and checks the packages it is configured to look for. If the package version has
been updated, the client requests the transfer.
AirBEAM License
The AirBEAM client is a licensed software product. The AirBEAM client's version
synchronization functionality is enabled through a license key file that is stored on the client
device. The license key file can be built into AirBEAM client's image, or downloaded in a
special AirBEAM package.
The AirBEAM license key file contains a unique key and a customer specific banner that is
displayed when the AirBEAM client version synchronization logic is invoked.
Configuring the AirBEAM Client
1. Tap the
icon on the SPT 1800 terminal screen to open the Applications
Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon. The main AirBEAM screen is displayed.
3. Tap the
icon to open the AirBEAM menus and select Preferences.
The AirBEAM Preferences screen is used to view and edit
AirBEAM client configurations. This screen has five selections in
the category pick list that you can modify - Packages(1),
Packages(2), Server, Misc(1) and Misc(2).
12-4
Applications: AirBEAM
Packages(1) Screen
Select Package(1) from the category pick list. This screen is used
to specify the package name of the first four of eight packages that
are to be loaded during the AirBEAM synchronization process.
The specified package name must correspond to a package that is
available on the specified package server.
Field
Description
Package 1
Package name of the first of eight packages. This is an optional field.
Package 2
Package name of the second of eight packages. This is an optional field.
Package 3
Package name of the third of eight packages. This is an optional field.
Package 4
Package name of the fourth of eight packages. This is an optional field.
Packages(2) Screen
Select Package(2) from the category pick list. This screen is used
to specify the package name of the last four of eight packages that
are to be loaded during the AirBEAM synchronization process.
The specified package name must correspond to a package that
is available on the specified package server.
Field
Description
Package 5
Package name of the fifth of eight packages. This is an optional field.
Package 6
Package name of the sixth of eight packages. This is an optional field.
Package 7
Package name of the seventh of eight packages. This is an optional field.
Package 8
Package name of the eighth of eight packages. This is an optional field.
Upload
Package
Package name of a package that is to be processed for “upload files” during the
AirBEAM synchronization process. The specified package name must
correspond to a package that is available on the specified package server.
This is an optional field.
12-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Server Screen
Select Server from the category pick list. This screen is used to
specify the configurations of the server to which the client will
connect during the package synchronization process.
Field
Description
IP Address
The IP Address of the server. It may be a host name or a dot notation format.
Directory
The directory on the server that contains the AirBEAM package definition files. All
AirBEAM package definition files are retrieved from this directory during the
package synchronization process.
User
The FTP user name that will be used during the login phase of the package
synchronization process.
Password
The FTP password that corresponds to the FTP user specified in the User field. The
specified password will be used during the login phase of the package
synchronization process.
12-6
Applications: AirBEAM
Misc(1) Screen
Select Misc(1) from the category pick list. This screen is used to
configure various miscellaneous features.
Field
Auto-load
Description
This drop-down menu is used to specify how the AirBEAM client is to be invoked
automatically when the client device is rebooted. The selections are:
Disable: the AirBEAM client is not invoked automatically during the boot
sequence.
Interactive: the AirBEAM client is invoked automatically during the boot
sequence. The package synchronization process is started automatically. The
Synchronization Dialog box is displayed, and the user is required to press the
OK button when the process is complete.
Non-interactive: the AirBEAM client is invoked automatically during the boot
sequence. The package synchronization process is started automatically. The
Synchronization Dialog box is displayed, but the user is not required to press
the OK button when the process is complete. The Synchronization Dialog box
terminates automatically.
RAM
Management
This checkbox specifies whether the automatic RAM management will be enabled
during the package synchronization process.
If enabled, RAM management logic will be invoked when there is not enough free
disk space to download a package. The RAM management logic will attempt to
remove any discardable AirBEAM packages resident on the client.
12-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Field
Description
Suppress
Separator
This checkbox specifies whether the automatic insertion is a file path separator
character should be suppressed when the client generated server package
definition file names.
When enabled, the parameter also disables the appending of .apd to the package.
This feature is useful for AS/400 systems, in which the file path separator character
is a period. When this feature is enabled, the server directory (Directory) and
package name (Package 1, Package 2, Package 3 and Package 4) are appended
“as is” when building the name for the server package definition file.
When this feature is disabled, a standard file path separator is used to separate the
server directory (Directory) and package name (Package 1, Package 2, Package 3
and Package 4) when building the name for the server package definition file. In
addition, an .apd extension is appended automatically.
TFTP
This checkbox specifies whether the TFTP protocol is to be used to download files.
By default, the AirBEAM client will use the FTP protocol.
WNMS
This checkbox specifies whether the AirBEAM client will upload a WNMS
information file at the end of each version synchronization.
12-8
Applications: AirBEAM
Misc(2) Screen
Select Misc(2) from the category pick list. This screen is used to
configure various miscellaneous features.
Field
Auto-retry
Description
This field is used to specify whether the AirBEAM client will automatically retry if
there is a failure during the synchronization process.
If this feature is enabled, the AirBEAM Client will display a popup dialog indicating
that a retry will be attempted. The popup dialog is displayed for the number of
seconds specified in the Retry delay field.
The valid values for this field are:
-1: the AirBEAM client will automatically retry indefinitely.
0: the AirBEAM client will not automatically retry.
>0: the AirBEAM client will automatically retry up to the number of times
specified.
Retry Delay
This field specifies the amount of time, in seconds, that the AirBEAM client will
delay before automatically retrying after a synchronization failure.
Synchronizing with the Server
When the synchronization process is initiated, the AirBEAM client attempts to open an FTP
session using the AirBEAM Client configuration. Once connected, the client processes the
specified packages. Packages are loaded only if the server version of a given package is
different from the version loaded on the client. Once the upload process is complete, the
AirBEAM client closes the FTP session with the server.
The AirBEAM client can launch an FTP session with the server either manually, when
initiated by the user or automatically.
12-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Manual Synchronization
1. Configure the AirBEAM Client. See Configuring the AirBEAM Client on page 12-4.
2. From the main AirBEAM screen, tap the
select Synchronize.
icon to open the AirBEAM menus and
3. The Service Connection Progress dialog box appears.
4. Once connected, the AirBEAM Synchronization screen
appears.
a. The Status List displays status messages that indicate
the progress of the synchronization process.
b. The Done button returns to the Main Menu. This button
remains inactive until the synchronization process is
complete.
c. The Retry button restarts the synchronization process.
This button is activated only if there is an error during
the synchronization process.
Automatic Synchronization
The AirBEAM client can be configured to launch automatically using the Misc(1) Preference
screen (see Misc(1) Screen on page 12-7). When setting this screen, use the Auto-load
drop-down menu is to specify how the AirBEAM client should be invoked automatically
when the client device is rebooted. The selections are:
•
Disable: the AirBEAM client is not invoked automatically during the boot sequence.
•
Interactive: the AirBEAM client is invoked automatically during the boot sequence.
The package synchronization process is started automatically. The
Synchronization Dialog box is displayed, and the user is required to press the OK
button when the process is complete.
•
Non-interactive: the AirBEAM client is invoked automatically during the boot
sequence. The package synchronization process is started automatically. The
Synchronization Dialog box is displayed, but the user is not required to press the
OK button when the process is complete. The Synchronization Dialog box
terminates automatically.
12-10
Chapter 13
Applications: Preferences
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3
Buttons Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3
Pen Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
HotSync Buttons Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
Connection Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7
Digitizer Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Formats Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Country Default. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Time, Date, Week Start and Numbers Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
Date & Time Preference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
Setting the Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
Setting the Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
Setting the Time Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-12
General Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
Auto-Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
Stay On In Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
System, Alarm and Game Sounds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Beam Receive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Kerberos Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Network Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Selecting a Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-15
Entering a User Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16
Entering a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16
Adding Connection Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-17
Connecting to Your Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20
Creating Additional Service Templates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20
13-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Adding Detailed Information to a Service Template. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-21
Idle Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-22
Defining Primary and Secondary DNS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-23
IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-24
Creating a Login Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-25
Deleting a Service Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-27
Network Preferences Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-27
Service Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-27
Options Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-28
TCP/IP Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-28
Owner Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-29
ShortCuts Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-30
Creating a ShortCut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-30
Editing a ShortCut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-31
Deleting a ShortCut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-31
Symbol Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-32
Trigger Wake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-32
High Beep . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-32
Trigger Sled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-32
13-2
Applications: Preferences
Introduction
The Preferences screens enable you to customize the configuration options on your
SPT 1800 terminal.
With the Preferences screens, you can:
•
Set the current date and time, the auto shut-off interval, and the overall, system,
alarm and game sounds.
•
Set the display format for dates, times and numbers.
•
Configure your SPT 1800 series terminal for use with a modem.
•
Assign your name, phone number and other owner information to your SPT 1800
series terminal.
•
Assign different applications to the buttons on the front panel of your SPT 1800
series terminal.
•
Define a list of Graffiti 2 abbreviations.
•
Calibrate the screen on your SPT 1800 series terminal.
•
Configure your SPT 1800 series terminal for use with a network, including
Spectrum24 (SPT 184x only) and CDPD (SPT 1833).
To open the Preferences screens:
1. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to display the last Preferences screen you used.
3. Tap the pick list in the upper-right corner to select the Preferences screen you want
to view.
Buttons Preferences
The Buttons Preferences screen enables you to associate different applications with the
buttons on the front of the SPT 1800 terminal. For example, if you find that you seldom use
the To Do List application and often use the Expense application, you can assign the To Do
List button to start the Expense application.
Any changes you make in the Buttons Preferences screen become effective immediately;
you do not have to switch to a different screen or application.
If you assign a different application to a button, you can still access the original application
using the Applications Launcher. Refer to Applications on page 3-3.
13-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To change the Buttons Preferences:
1. On the General Preferences screen choose Buttons from the pick list. This displays
a list of all the applications installed on your SPT 1800 terminal.
Tap arrow to
show pick list
2. Tap the pick list next to the application you want to re-assign a button.
3. Select the new button.
Note: To restore all of the buttons to their factory settings, tap the Default
button.
13-4
Applications: Preferences
Pen Preferences
The Buttons Preferences screen enables you to change the Button assignment of the fullscreen pen stroke. By default, the full-screen pen stroke activates the Graffiti 2 Help screen.
Drag to top of screen
To change the Pen preferences:
1. Tap the Pen button in the Buttons Preferences screen to open the Pen screen.
2. Tap the pick list and select one of the following settings for the full-screen pen
stroke:
Backlight
Activates the backlight feature of the SPT 1800 terminal. You
can use this setting instead of the power button to turn the
backlight on and off.
Keyboard
Activates the on-screen keyboard for entering text characters.
13-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Graffiti Help
Activates a series of screens that show the complete Graffiti
pen stroke character set.
Turn Off & Lock Turns off and locks the SPT 1800 terminal. You must assign a
password to lock the SPT 1800 terminal. When locked, you
need to enter the password to unlock and use your SPT 1800
terminal.
Beam Data
Beams the current entry to another terminal.
3. Tap the OK button to complete your selection and return to the Buttons Preferences
screen.
HotSync Buttons Preferences
The Buttons Preferences screen also enables you to associate different applications with
the HotSync button on the CRD1700-1000S. Any changes that you make in the HotSync
Buttons screen are effective immediately; you do not have to change to a different screen
or application.
To change the HotSync Buttons preferences:
1. Tap the HotSync button in the Buttons Preferences screen to open the HotSync
Buttons screen.
2. Tap the pick list next to the button you want to assign to display a list of all the
applications installed on your SPT 1800 terminal.
Tap arrow to
show pick list
3. Tap the application that you want to assign to each button. The default setting for
each button is the HotSync setting, which means the cradle and optional device
accessory perform their normal HotSync functions.
13-6
Applications: Preferences
Connection Preferences
The Connection Preferences screen enables you to define the settings for the serial,
modem, and IR communications.
To define the Connection Preferences:
1. Tap the
icon to display the last Preferences screen you used.
2. Tap the pick list in the upper-right corner and select Connection. The following
screen displays:
3. Tap the modem you want to configure and tap New for a new configuration, or Edit
to re-configure an existing one. The Edit screen displays:
13-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Name
If the configuration is new, enter the name of the modem
connected to the SPT 1800 terminal using the onscreen
keyboard. If it is an existing configuration, the modem name
displays.
Connection
Method
The preferred method of communication.
Note: The SPT 1833 terminal can connect via Merlin to PC.
Dialing
Select either Touch Tone or Rotary. Select Rotary only if you
are certain that your telephone service does not support Touch
Tone dialing.
Volume
Speaker volume for the modem.
Note: The Dialing and Volume settings are not configurable for
all Connection Methods and may not display your screen.
4. Tap the Details button. The following screen displays:
5. Tap the Speed pick list and select the speed for communication.
6. Tap the Flow Ctl (Flow Control) pick list and select either Automatic, On or Off Flow
Control for the modem connection.
7. If necessary, edit the Init String text to change the modem setup string.
13-8
Applications: Preferences
Digitizer Preferences
The Digitizer Preferences screen activates the digitizer calibration screen. This is the same
screen that displays when you start your SPT 1800 terminal for the first time. Tap each
target that appears on the screen.
Formats Preferences
Use the Formats Preferences screen to set the display format of the country, dates, times
and numbers on your SPT 1800 terminal.
Country Default
The country default sets date, time, week start day and number conventions based on
geographic regions where you might use your SPT 1800 terminal. For example, in the
United Kingdom, time often is expressed based on a 24-hour clock. In the United States it
is based on a 12-hour clock with an AM or PM suffix.
All your SPT 1800 terminal applications use the Country default settings. You can, however,
customize your own preferences as described in Time, Date, Week Start and Numbers
Formats on page 13-10.
To set the country default:
1. In the Formats Preferences screen, tap the Preset To pick list. The following screen
displays:
2. Tap the country you want to use.
13-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Time, Date, Week Start and Numbers Formats
These settings define the defaults. Note that the format that you select appears in all
applications on your SPT 1800 terminal.
To select the Time, Date, Week start and Numbers format:
1. Tap the Time pick list in the Formats Preferences screen, and select the format that
you want for your SPT 1800 terminal.
2. Tap the Date pick list and select the format that you want for your SPT 1800
terminal.
3. Tap the Week starts pick list and select whether you want the first day of the week
to be either Sunday or Monday.
4. Tap the Numbers pick list and select the format that you want for your SPT 1800
terminal.
Note: This setting controls the Day, Week and Month views in the Date
Book application and all other aspects of your SPT 1800 terminal
that display a calendar.
Date & Time Preference
The Date & Time Preferences screen lets you set the date, time and time zone for your
device.
13-10
Applications: Preferences
Setting the Date
To set the date:
1. Tap the Applications Launcher icon, then tap the Prefs icon.
2. From the pick list in the upper right corner, tap Date & Time.
3. On the Date & Time screen, tap the Set Date box; then tap the arrows at the top of
the Set Date screen to select the current year.
Tap arrows to select year
Tap to select month
Tap to select date
4. Tap the month; then tap the current date.
The screen closes and the dates you selected are displayed in the Set Date box.
Setting the Time
To set the time:
1. Tap the Applications Launcher icon; then tap the Prefs icon.
2. From the pick list in the upper right corner, tap Date & Time.
3. On the Date & Time screen, tap the Set Time box; then tap the Up or Down arrow
to change the hour.
Tap here
13-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
4. Tap each minute number, and then tap an arrow to change the number.
5. If available, tap AM or PM.
6. Tap OK to set the new time and return to the Date & Time screen.
Note: To display time based on a 24-hour clock, change the time format.
See Time, Date, Week Start and Numbers Formats on page 13-10.
Setting the Time Zone
To set the time zone:
1. Tap the Applications icon; then tap the Prefs icon.
2. From the pick list in the upper right corner, tap Date & Time.
3. On the Preferences screen, tap the Set Time Zone box.
4. Use the up and down arrows to scroll to your country and time zone. The hardware
scroll buttons can be used to scroll the list a page at a time.
5. Make sure your time zone is highlighted, then tap OK.
Tip: Choose the time zone from the list that corresponds to where you are. When
you travel, use this dialog to change time zones. If you’re not sure what time zone
you are in, find out what time it is, and select the time zone which shows the current
new time. Do not use the time zone dialog to switch between daylight savings time
and standard time. Use the Daylight Savings pick list.
The screen closes and the dates you selected are displayed in the Date & Time screen.
To set daylight savings time:
1. Tap the Applications Launcher icon, then select Date & Time from the pick list in
the upper right corner of the screen.
13-12
Applications: Preferences
2. Tap on the Daylight Saving pick list to toggle this feature on or off.
General Preferences
The General Preferences screen is where you set the auto shut-off interval and sounds for
your SPT 1800 terminal.
Auto-Off
Your SPT 1800 terminal has an automatic shutoff feature that turns off the power and
backlight after a period of inactivity. This feature helps conserve battery power in case you
forget to turn off your SPT 1800 terminal.
If you find that your SPT 1800 terminal shuts itself off before you finish reviewing the
information on the screen, increase the time setting of the automatic shutoff feature.
To set the Auto-off delay:
1. Tap Auto-off After in the General Preferences screen to open the pick list.
2. Tap the setting you want to use for the automatic shutoff feature. You can choose
a delay of 30 seconds, 1 minute, 2 minutes or 3 minutes.
Stay On In Cradle
This option is used to control whether the SPT 1800 terminal stays powered on while it is
in the cradle. To force the terminal to stay on while it is seated in the cradle, check this box.
13-13
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
System, Alarm and Game Sounds
Your SPT 1800 terminal uses a variety of sounds. The System, Alarm and Game Sound
settings enable you to turn the sounds on or off, and on to adjust the volume level.
To set the System, Alarm and Game sounds, tap each option’s pick list and select the sound
level.
Note: When you turn off the System Sounds, you also turn off the “chime”
tones associated with the HotSync operation. The Game Sound
setting works only with games that are programmed to respond to
this setting. Older games typically do not respond to this setting.
Beam Receive
The Beam Receive preference controls the IRDA receiving. Refer to Beaming Information
to Other SPT 1800 Terminals on page 3-27 for details.
Kerberos Preferences
The Kerberos Preferences enables you to configure the Kerberos Authentication settings
on the terminal. You can also enable Kerberos in the Network Preferences. To enable
Kerberos, tap the Enabled checkbox.
Refer to SPT 1846 Configuration on page 2-7 for setting Kerberos detail information.
Network Preferences
The Network Preferences settings enable you to use the TCP/IP software that comes with
your SPT 1800 terminal operating system to connect with Internet Service Providers (ISPs)
or dial-in (remote access) servers. For instructions on configuring your terminal for use with
a Spectrum24 or CDPD network refer to Chapter 2, Network Setup.
13-14
Applications: Preferences
To use TCP/IP, you must first create a configuration in Connection Preferences and then
create Network preference settings.
Note: Connection preferences settings enable your SPT 1800 terminal to
use an external modem to communicate with remote devices. For
example, you can communicate with your computer if you are away
on travel or your ISP server. Refer to Connection Preferences on
page 13-7 for a complete explanation on how to configure modem
parameters.
After you configure both the Network and Connection (modem) Preferences, you can
establish a PPP (Point-to-Point Protocol), SLIP (Serial Line Internet Protocol) or CSLIP
(Compressed Serial Line Internet Protocol) connection with your ISP or dial-in server, by
using menu commands from the Network Preferences screen or by using a third-party
application.
Note: TCP/IP provides the ability to connect to your ISP or dial-in server,
however, it does not come with any applications to view the
transmitted data. Visit the Symbol website (http://www.symbol.com/
palm) for information on third-party applications that take advantage
of TCP/IP.
Selecting a Service
Use the Service setting to choose the service template for your Internet Service Provider
or a dial-in server. Service templates are a set of ISP and dial-in server configuration
settings that you can create, save and reuse.
To select a service:
1. Tap the Service pick list in the Network Preference screen to display a list of all the
predefined service templates.
13-15
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Tap here to display a list
of service templates
2. Tap the service you want to use.
Entering a User Name
The User Name setting identifies the name you use when you log into your Internet Service
Provider or your dial-in server. Although this field can contain multiple lines of text, only two
lines display on the screen.
To enter a user name:
1. Tap the User Name line in the Network Preferences screen to move the cursor to
that field.
2. Enter your user name.
Note: Most dial-in servers do not accept spaces in the user name.
Entering a Password
The Password field identifies the password you use to log into your server or ISP. Your entry
in this field determines whether your SPT 1800 terminal prompts you to enter a password
each time you log into your network.
If you do not enter a password, your SPT 1800 terminal displays the word “Prompt” in this
field and asks you to enter a password during the login procedure. If you enter a password,
your SPT 1800 terminal displays the word “Assigned” in this field and does not prompt you
to enter a password during the login procedure.
13-16
Applications: Preferences
Note: If you are concerned about security, select the Prompt option and do
not enter a password.
To enter a password:
1. Tap the Password box in the Network Preferences screen to open the Password
screen.
Enter password here
Tap here
2. Enter the password you use to log into your server.
3. Tap OK to confirm your entry and return to the Network Preferences screen.
Note: The Password field updates to display the word “Assigned.”
Adding Connection Settings
Use the Connection pick list to choose your modem.
When you select the Phone field, your SPT 1800 terminal opens a screen where you define
the telephone number you use to connect with your ISP or dial-in server. In addition, use
this screen to define a prefix, disable Call Waiting and give special instructions for using a
calling card.
Note: The phone setup screen works correctly for AT&T and Sprint longdistance services. However, MCI customers need to put the calling
card number in the Phone field and the phone number in the Calling
Card field.
13-17
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To enter your server phone number:
1. Tap the Phone field to open the Phone Setup screen.
Enter your ISP
phone number here
2. Enter the phone number you use to reach your ISP or dial-in server.
Entering a Prefix
A prefix is a number that you dial before the telephone number to access an outside line.
For example, many offices require that you dial “9” to dial a number outside the building.
To enter a prefix:
1. Select the Dial Prefix check box to activate this feature.
Select this box
if you need to
use a prefix
Enter your
prefix here
2. Enter the prefix you need on the Prefix line.
3. Tap OK to confirm your selection and return to the Network Preferences screen.
13-18
Applications: Preferences
Disabling Call Waiting
Call Waiting can cause your session to terminate if you receive a call while you are
connected. If your telephone has Call Waiting, disable this feature before logging into your
ISP or dial-in server.
To disable Call Waiting:
1. Select the Disable call waiting check box to activate this feature.
Select this box
if you need to
disable Call
Waiting
Enter your disable
code here
2. Enter the code to disable Call Waiting on the Disable call waiting line.
Note: Each telephone company assigns a code to disable Call Waiting.
Contact your local telephone company for the code that is
appropriate for you.
Using a Calling Card
The Use Calling Card field enables you to use your calling card when dialing your ISP or
Intranet server. There is usually a delay before you enter your calling card number. When
you define your calling card number, add commas at the beginning to compensate for this
delay. Each comma delays transmission of your calling card number for two seconds.
To use a calling card:
13-19
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
1. Select the Use Calling Card check box to activate this feature.
Select this box to
use a calling card
Enter your
calling card
number here
2. Enter your calling card number on the Use Calling Card line.
Note: It’s a good idea to add at least three commas at the beginning of your
calling card number to compensate for the cue delay.
3. Tap OK to confirm your selection and return to the Network Preferences screen.
Connecting to Your Service
After you set your Modem and Network Preferences, establishing a connection to your ISP
or dial-in server is easy.
Remember that you need a third-party application, such as a web browser or news reader,
to take advantage of this connection. Check the Symbol website (http://www.symbol.com/
palm) for the latest information about third-party applications that support SPT TCP/IP.
To establish a connection, tap the Connect button in the Network Preferences screen to dial
the current service and display the Service Connection Progress messages.
Tip: To see expanded Service Connection Progress messages, press the lower
half of the scroll button.
To close a connection, tap the Disconnect button in the Network Preferences screen to
terminate the connection between your SPT 1800 terminal and your service.
Creating Additional Service Templates
You can create additional service templates from scratch or by duplicating existing
templates and editing information. After you create a new or duplicate template, you can
add and edit settings.
13-20
Applications: Preferences
To add a new service template:
1. Tap the
icon in the Network Preferences screen to open the menus.
2. Tap New from the Service menu to create a new service template (called Untitled)
to the Service pick list and display it in the Network Preferences screen.
To duplicate an existing service template:
1. Tap the Service pick list in the Network Preference screen to open a list of all the
predefined service templates.
2. Tap the service you want to duplicate.
3. Tap the
icon to open the Network Preferences menus.
4. Tap Duplicate from the Service menu to add a copy of the service template to the
Service pick list and display it in the Network Preferences screen.
Adding Detailed Information to a Service Template
If you are using one of the predefined service templates, you will probably only need to
enter your user name and telephone number. If you are creating a new Service Templates,
you may need to provide additional information to your ISP or dial-in server. Use the Details
screen to add additional information to a selected service template.
13-21
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To select a connection type:
1. Tap the service you want to use in the Network Preferences screen.
2. Tap the Details button to open the Details screen.
Select connection type
3. Tap the Connection type pick list and select one of the following connection types:
PPP
Point-to-Point protocol
SLIP
Serial Line Internet Protocol
CSLIP Compressed Serial Line Internet Protocol
Note: If you are not sure, try PPP; if that doesn’t work, ask your Internet
Service Provider or your System Administrator for the correct
connection type.
Idle Timeout
The Idle Timeout setting defines how long your SPT 1800 terminal waits before dropping
the connection with your ISP or dial-in server when you switch out of a TCP/IP application.
To set the Idle Timeout:
1. Tap the Idle Timeout pick list and select one of the following options:
13-22
Immediate
Your SPT 1800 terminal drops the connection to your ISP
immediately when you switch to another application.
1 minute
Your SPT 1800 terminal waits one minute for you to open
another application before it drops the connection.
Applications: Preferences
2 minutes
Your SPT 1800 terminal waits two minutes for you to open
another application before it drops the connection.
3 minutes
Your SPT 1800 terminal waits three minutes for you to open
another application before it drops the connection.
Power Off
Your SPT 1800 terminal keeps your PPP or SLIP connection
until you power off your SPT 1800 terminal (or until it times out).
This option works best with the PalmPilot Modem.
2. Tap the OK button to confirm your selection and return to the Network Preferences
screen.
Defining Primary and Secondary DNS
The Domain Naming System (DNS) is a mechanism in the Internet for translating names
of host computers into IP addresses. When you enter a DNS number (or IP address), you
are identifying a specific server that handles the translation services.
Each IP address has four sections, separated by periods. In the Details screen, enter each
section separately. Each section of an IP address is made up of a number from 0 to 255;
numbers are the only allowable characters in this field.
Note: Ask your Internet Service Provider or System Administrator for the
correct Primary or Secondary DNS IP numbers.
Tip: Many systems do not require that you enter a DNS. If you are not sure, leave
the DNS field blank. Note that if your ISP or dial-in server requires a DNS number
and you did not enter that information in the Network Preferences screen, it will
appear that you successfully logged into your network. However, when you try to
use an application or look up information, the connection fails. If this occurs, try
adding a DNS number. Ask your ISP or your System Administrator for the correct
Primary and Secondary DNS IP numbers.
To enter a primary and secondary DNS:
1. Make sure the Query DNS check box is not selected.
Note: If the Query DNS check box is selected, it queries the connection
(modem) for the saved DNS information.
13-23
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
2. Tap the space to the left of the first period in the Primary DNS field, then enter the
first section of the IP address.
Note: Each section must be a number from 0 to 255.
3. Tap the second section of the Primary DNS field, then enter the second section of
the IP address, and so on until the sections are completed.
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for the Secondary DNS number.
5. Tap the OK button to confirm your selection and return to the Network Preferences
screen.
IP Address
Everyone who logs on to the Internet needs to have a unique identifier (an IP address),
whether permanent or temporary. Some networks dynamically assign a temporary IP
address when clients log in. The IP Address field lets you identify whether your network
provides automatic (dynamic) temporary IP addressing.
Note: If your IP address is permanently assigned, you will need to get that
information from your System Administrator. If you are not sure,
select Automatic.
To identify dynamic IP addressing, select the IP Address check box to activate this option.
Tap to have the
IP address
automatically
assigned
13-24
Applications: Preferences
To enter a permanent IP address:
1. Clear the IP Address check box to disable this option and display a permanent IP
address field below the check box.
Enter the IP address here
2. Tap the space to the left of the first period then enter the first section of the IP
address.
Note: Each section must be a number from 0 to 255.
3. Tap and enter the remaining sections of the IP address.
4. Tap the OK button to confirm your selection and return to the Network Preferences
screen.
Creating a Login Script
A login script is a series of commands, similar to an autoexec.bat file, that automates
logging into your ISP. You can create login script files by selecting commands from the
Command pick list in the Login Script screen. Some of these commands, such as Send,
require you to supply additional information and have a parameter field for the necessary
data.
Note: You can also use non-ASCII and literal characters in your login
script. Refer to Appendix A, Non-ASCII Characters for Login Scripts
for additional information.
13-25
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To create a login script:
1. Tap the Script button in the Details screen to open the Login Script screen.
2. Tap the End pick list to open the Command list.
3. Tap the command(s) you want from the Command list.
4. If the command requires additional information, a field displays to the right of it for
you to enter the information. The following commands are available:
Wait For
Tells your SPT 1800 terminal to wait for specific characters from
the TCP/IP server before executing the next command.
Wait For
Prompt
Tells your SPT 1800 terminal to wait for a prompt before executing
the next command.
Send
Transmits specific characters to the TCP/IP server to which you
are connecting.
Send CR
Transmits a carriage return or LF character to the TCP/IP server
to which you are connecting.
Send User ID Transmits the User ID information entered in the User ID field of
the Network Preferences screen.
13-26
Send
Password
Transmits the Password entered in the Password field of the
Network Preferences screen. If you did not enter a password in
the Password field, this command prompts you to enter one. The
Password command is usually followed by a Send CR command.
Delay
Tells your SPT 1800 terminal to wait a specific number of seconds
before executing the next command in the login script.
Get IP
Reads an IP address and uses it as the IP address for your SPT
1800 terminal. This command is used with SLIP connections.
Applications: Preferences
Prompt
Opens a screen and prompts you to enter text of some kind (for
example, a password or a security code).
End
Identifies the last line in the login script.
5. Repeat steps 2 and 3 until the login script is complete.
6. Tap OK to confirm your selection and return to the Details screen.
Deleting a Service Template
To delete a service template:
1. Tap the Service pick list in the Network Preference screen to open a list of available
service templates.
2. Tap the service you want to delete.
3. Tap the
icon to open the menus for the Network Preferences screen.
4. Tap Delete from the Service menu to display the Delete Service alert.
5. Tap the OK button to confirm that you want to delete the service template.
Network Preferences Menu Commands
The Network Preferences screen includes menu commands to make it fast and easy to
create and edit service templates. This section explains the menu commands that are
specific to the SPT TCP/IP application.
Refer to Using Menus on page 3-18 for information about menu commands that are
common to all of your SPT 1800 terminal applications.
Service Menu
When you select the Service menu, its commands display on screen.
New
Creates a new (empty) service template and adds it to the
Service pick list.
Delete
Deletes a selected service template from the Service pick list.
Duplicate
Copies the selected service template and adds it to the Service
pick list.
13-27
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Options Menu
When you select the Options menu, its command displays on screen:
View Log
Displays the Network Log screen.
TCP/IP Troubleshooting
If you are having a problem establishing a network connection using the Desktop TCP/IP,
check this section and try the suggestions listed.
Displaying Expanded Service Connection Progress Messages
It’s helpful to identify at what point in the login procedure the connection fails. An easy way
to do this is to display the expanded Service Connection Progress messages, which
describe the current stage of the login procedure.
To display the expanded Service Connection Progress messages:
1. From the Network Preferences screen, tap Connect.
2. During login, press the lower half of the scroll button to display the messages.
Viewing the Network Log
If viewing the expanded Service Connection Progress messages does not give you enough
information to find out why you cannot connect to your ISP or dial-in server, look at the
Network Log. The Network Log lists all communication that occurs between your modem
and your dial-in server during the login procedure. The information in the Network Log can
help your ISP or your System Administrator pinpoint where the login procedure
communication fails and why.
To view the Network Log:
1. From the Network Preferences screen, tap View Log from the Options menu to
display the Network Log screen.
2. Tap the up and down arrows of the scroll bar to see the entire Network Log.
3. After you finish, tap the Done button to return to the Network Preferences screen.
13-28
Applications: Preferences
Owner Preferences
The Owner Preferences screen enables you to record a name, company name, phone
number or any other information that you want associated with your SPT 1800 terminal.
If you use the Security application to turn off and lock your SPT 1800 terminal with a
password, information that you put in the Owner Preferences displays the next time you
turn on your SPT 1800 terminal. Refer to Chapter 14, Applications: Security for more
information.
To personalize your SPT1800 terminal:
1. Tap the Applications icon, followed by the Prefs icon.
2. Select Owner from the Preferences pick list.
Enter the text that you want to associate with your SPT 1800 terminal in the Owner
Preferences screen. If you enter more text than will fit on one screen, a scroll bar
automatically displays on the right side of the screen.
If you assign a Password (with the Security application), the information in the Owner
Preferences screen “locks” and cannot be changed. In this case, an Unlock button displays
at the bottom of the screen.
To unlock the Owner Preferences screen:
1. Tap the Unlock button in the Owner Preferences screen. The Unlock Message
screen displays.
2. Enter the password that you defined in the Security application, and tap the OK
button.
13-29
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
ShortCuts Preferences
The ShortCuts Preferences screen enables you to define abbreviations for entering text
with Graffiti. This section describes how to create, edit and delete a shortcut. For details on
the use of ShortCuts, refer to the Using Graffiti 2 ShortCuts on page 3-13.
Creating a ShortCut
You can create a ShortCut for any words, letters or numbers. All ShortCuts you create
display on the list in the ShortCut Preferences screen. All the ShortCuts are available in any
of your SPT 1800 terminal applications and are backed up on your computer when you
perform a HotSync operation.
To create a ShortCut:
1. In the General Preferences screen tap, tap Shortcuts in the pick list and tap New
to open the ShortCut Entry screen.
Tap New
2. On the ShortCut name line, enter the letters you want to use to activate the
ShortCut.
3. Tap the ShortCut Text area and enter the text that you want to appear when you
write the ShortCut characters.
Tip: You may want to add a space (space character) after the last word in your
ShortCut text. This way, a space automatically follows the ShortCut text.
4. Tap the OK button to close the ShortCut Entry screen and define your ShortCut.
13-30
Applications: Preferences
Tip: To use a ShortCut, draw the ShortCut stroke followed by the ShortCut
characters. When you draw the ShortCut stroke, the ShortCut symbol appears at
the insertion point to show that you are in ShortCut mode.
ShortCut
Editing a ShortCut
After you create a ShortCut, you can modify it at any time.
To edit a ShortCut:
1. Tap the ShortCut you want to edit in the ShortCuts Preferences screen.
2. Tap the Edit button to display the ShortCut Name and ShortCut text in the ShortCut
Entry screen.
3. Make the changes you want and tap the OK button.
Deleting a ShortCut
If you no longer need a ShortCut, you can delete it from the list of ShortCuts.
To delete a ShortCut:
1. Tap the ShortCut you want to delete in the ShortCuts Preferences screen.
2. Tap the Delete button to display an alert screen.
3. Tap the Yes button to confirm that you want to delete the ShortCut.
13-31
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Symbol Preferences
The Symbol Preferences screen enables you to change specific terminal settings.
Trigger Wake
Your SPT 1800 terminal can be “awakened” or powered on by pressing any one of the
scanner buttons. If you want this feature enabled, tap the Trigger Wake check box. If you
do not check this option, the scanner buttons will not awaken the terminal.
High Beep
The High Beep settings enable you to increase the volume of the system, alarm and game
sounds. To enable high volume, tap the check box.
Trigger Sled
The Trigger Sled setting enables or disables the Trigger Handle accessory when attached
to the terminal.
13-32
Chapter 14
Applications: Security
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Assigning a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hiding Private Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Showing Private Entries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Masking Private Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Locking Your SPT 1800 Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing or Deleting a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Recovering from a Lost Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14-3
14-3
14-4
14-5
14-5
14-6
14-7
14-8
14-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
14-2
Applications: Security
Introduction
Your SPT 1800 terminal comes with a Security application so that unauthorized users
cannot view the entries you wish to protect.
With the Security application you can:
•
Hide record entries you mark as “Private.” You can hide private entries with or
without a password. Without a password, private entries are hidden until you set
the Security application to show them. With a password, you must enter the
password to view the private entries.
•
Turn off and lock your SPT 1800 terminal so that it does not operate until you enter
the correct password.
To open the Security application:
1. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to display the Security screen.
Assigning a Password
You can assign a password to protect your private entries and to lock your SPT 1800
terminal.
To assign a password:
1. Select the Security icon, then tap the Password box to open the Password screen.
Tap here
2. Enter the password that you want for your SPT 1800 terminal.
3. Enter a word or phase that will give you a hint if you forgot your password.
4. Tap the OK button to open a confirmation screen.
14-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
5. Enter the same password a second time, and tap the OK button to assign that
password to your SPT 1800 terminal.
Hiding Private Entries
You can hide the entries that you mark as private. When hidden, they are not visible
anywhere in the list. If you assign a password, you must enter it to show entries you mark
as private. Note that your SPT 1800 terminal merely hides the entries; it does not delete
them.
To hide Private entries:
1. Select Hide Records from the Current Privacy pick list. The Hide Records screen
displays:
Tap here and
select Hide
Records
2. Tap Hide to hide entries you mark Private and to close the Hide Records screen.
14-4
Applications: Security
Showing Private Entries
After you hide Private entries, you can use the Security application to display them again.
To show Private entries:
1. Select Hide Records from the Current Privacy pick list. If you did not assign a
password, your Private entries should be visible. If you assigned a password, the
Show Private Records screen displays:
2. Enter your password.
3. Tap the Show box to close the Show Private Records screen and display Private
entries in your SPT 1800 terminal applications.
Masking Private Entries
When a private record is masked, a visual placeholder appears where a record would
normally be displayed.
To mask private entries:
1. Ensure that the record or records you want to mask are defined as Private. To
make a record private, select the record, tap Edit, Details, and then Private.
2. Select the Security icon.
3. Tap Mask Records from the Current Privacy pick list.
Return to the application. Messages marked as Private are masked with a gray bar.
14-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Locking Your SPT 1800 Terminal
You can also lock your SPT 1800 terminal, so that you need to enter your password to
operate it.
Important: If you lock your SPT 1800 terminal as described in the following procedure, you
need to enter the exact password to re-activate your SPT 1800 terminal. If you forget the
password, you must perform a hard reset to resume using your SPT 1800 terminal. Using
the reset button deletes all the entries in your SPT 1800 terminal; however, you can restore
all synchronized data at the next HotSync operation. For information about how to use the
reset button, See Performing a Hard Reset on page 18-5.
To lock your SPT 1800 terminal with a password:
1. Use the HotSync application to synchronize the data between your SPT 1800
terminal and your computer. Refer to Chapter 10, Applications: HotSync® for
information about how to use the HotSync application.
2. Assign a password as described in Assigning a Password on page 14-3.
3. Tap the Lock & Turn Off button in the Security screen to open the System Lockout
screen.
Tap here
4. Tap the Off & Lock button to turn off the power for your SPT 1800 terminal.
5. Start your SPT 1800 terminal and enter the password.
14-6
Applications: Security
Changing or Deleting a Password
Once you define a password for your SPT 1800 terminal, you can change or delete it at any
time. You must enter the current password before you can change or delete it.
To change or delete your password:
1. Tap the Assigned box in the Security screen to open the Password screen.
Tap here
2. Enter the current password.
3. Tap the OK button to open a screen that prompts you for a new password.
4. To change the password, enter the new password and tap the OK button. To delete
the password, tap the Unassign button.
14-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Recovering from a Lost Password
If the Off & Lock option is not active and you forget or lose your password, you can delete
the password from your SPT 1800 terminal. Deleting a lost password also deletes all entries
and files marked as Private.
Important: If you synchronize with your computer before deleting a lost password, your
SPT 1800 terminal restores your private entries the next time you perform a HotSync
operation, but it does not restore the password.
To delete a lost password:
1. Tap the Lost Password button in the Security screen to open the Delete Password
dialog.
2. Tap the Yes button to delete the password, as well as all records and entries
marked “Private.”
14-8
Chapter 15
Applications: Laser Scanner
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scanning with the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SScan Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SScan Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Demo Scan Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Demo Scan Menu Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scanning 1-D Bar Codes Using Demo Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Barcode Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scanning Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery Implications While Using the Laser Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15-3
15-3
15-3
15-3
15-4
15-6
15-7
15-7
15-8
15-9
15-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
15-2
Applications: Laser Scanner
Introduction
The SPT 1800 has an integrated scanner which allows you to collect data by scanning bar
codes, provided you have a scanning application loaded on your terminal. The laser is
emitted from the top of the unit.
Scanning with the SPT 1800
Included on the Symbol Palm Terminal Utility CD are two demonstration programs: SScan
and Demo Scan. These programs are designed to assist the applications developer in
writing an application for the scanner. Source code for these programs is located in the
Samples subdirectory of the Scanner SDK directory, and the prc files are located in the prc
subdirectory of the Scanner SDK directory. If your terminal does not contain these
demonstration programs, contact your distributor.
To add SScan.prc or ScanDemo.prc to the SPT 1800, use the SPT Install Tool to designate
the files to be added to the SPT 1800 during the next HotSync.
SScan Application
The SScan application is a basic scanning application. To scan bar codes with the SPT
1800 using SScan:
1. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to open SScan.
3. Aim the terminal at the bar code.
4. Tap the Scan button, or use the left or right trigger to activate the scan beam.
The scan LED lights and the laser beam is emitted from the top of the terminal. Make sure
the beam covers the entire bar code. A successful decode is indicated by a green LED and
a beep. The bar code data is displayed on the screen. In the Bar Type field, the type of
symbology (e.g., Code 39) is displayed. In the Bar Data field, the actual collected bar code
data displays.
SScan Menu Commands
Tap the
icon to display the available menu.
15-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Options Menu
When you select the Options menu, its commands display on screen:
Reset Defaults
Allows you to reset the default values.
About
Provides version information.
Demo Scan Application
The Demo Scan application allows you to customize your scanner’s features and scan bar
codes.
To open the Demo Scan application:
1. Tap the
icon to open the Applications Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon to open Demo Scan.
The Symbol Scanner Demo screen displays:
15-4
Applications: Laser Scanner
Available Symbologies
Allows you to select the symbologies to be
recognized by the scanner by tapping on the
box next to the name of the desired
symbology. When selected, the box has a
check mark.
Scan Enable
When this option is clicked, and the trigger is
pressed, the laser scanner beam activates.
The beam remains on for approximately 3
seconds. Alternatively, tapping on the Scan
button on the bottom of the screen performs
the same action.
LED
When this box is checked, the green LED
lights. This serves as a test of the LED. To
stop the LED test, tap the LED box again.
Trigger Mode
Level: only the SPT 1800 scan trigger initiates
the scan; the laser is turned off when the
trigger is released or the decode was
successful.
Pulse: only the SPT 1800 scan trigger initiates
the scan; the laser is turned off when
laser_on_time is reached or when the decode
was successful.
Host (default): The SPT 1800 scan trigger or
the application’s ScanCmdStartDecode
command initiates the scan; the laser is
turned off when the trigger is released, or
when laser_on_time is reached, the
ScanCmdStopDecode command is called, or
the decode was successful.
Bar Type
Once a bar code is decoded, displays the type
of the decoded bar codes (i.e., Code 39, Code
128, Code 93, etc.)
Bar Data
Once a bar code is decoded, displays the
decoded data.
15-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Demo Scan Menu Options
Tap the
icon to display the available menus.
Setup Menu
When you select the Setup menu, its commands display on screen:
Hardware Setting
Beep on Good
Decode
Determines if the terminal beeps to indicate a successful
decode.
Redundancy
Determines if the scanner uses redundancy.
Linear Security Defines the linear security level to be used by the scanner;
level 1, 2, 3, or 4.
Scan Angle
The SPT 1800 has a single set scan angle. This option is not
used.
Decode LED On Defines the length of time (in seconds) the decode LED
Time
remains on when a symbol is decoded.
Laser On Time
Defines the length of time (in seconds) the laser beam
remains on when the trigger is pressed.
Aim Duration
Defines the length of time the laser pointer beam remains on
when the trigger is pressed or the scan button is tapped.
Code Format Setting
Code ID Char
Defines the CodeID Character. The options are None, AIM
and Symbol.
Tx Format
Defines the data transmission format.
Prefix/Suffix
Defines the Prefix and Suffix values.
Beep Menu
This menu option allows you to customize the Frequency, Duration and Pattern of the
scanner’s beep.
15-6
Applications: Laser Scanner
Options Menu
When you select the Options menu, its commands display on screen:
Reset Defaults
Allows you to reset the default values.
About
Provides version information.
Scanning 1-D Bar Codes Using Demo Scan
To scan 1-D bar codes:
1. Tap the
icon to open Demo Scan.
2. Customize your scanner’s features by selecting from the various options described
previously.
3. Aim the scanner at the bar code.
4. Press either the right, left or center scan trigger or tap the Scan Button. Make sure
the red scan beam covers the entire bar code. The green scan LED lights and a
beep sounds to indicate a successful decode.
Barcode Application
The Barcode application is a basic receiving application, which demonstrates the terminal’s
scanning and signature capture capabilities. To use Barcode:
1. Select the Barcode icon
from your main application screen.
15-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
The Receiving Demo Screen displays:
Item Code
Contains the data for an item code once it is
scanned. A one or two-dimensional bar code
can be scanned to fill this field.
Quantity
This drop-down menu allows you to select the
appropriate quantity.
Location
Contains the location data for a location bar
code once it is scanned. You can also use
Graffiti to enter the location data in this field.
Only one-dimensional bar codes can be used
to fill this field.
Please Sign Here
Sign your name here using the stylus.
To submit the collected data, tap the Submit option. When the submission is
complete, the fields clear and you can continue collecting data.
Scanning Problems
If the bar code is not being decoded, check the following:
•
Make sure the bar code label is not defaced.
•
Make sure the bar code is of a symbology which can be read by the scanner.
15-8
Applications: Laser Scanner
•
Check that the scanner window is not dirty. If it is, gently clean it using a tissue or
other non-abrasive material. Do not spray any cleaner directly on the scanner
window.
•
Try another bar code. It is possible that your bar code is bad.
•
Check your application code.
•
Make sure the parameters are set correctly for the bar code being scanned; i.e.,
lengths, symbology, etc.
If you do not hear a beep after a good decode, check that the system sound option is set
in the general preferences screen, and that Beep on Good Decode is set in the hardware
setup. Refer to Demo Scan Menu Options on page 15-6 for details.
If you have checked all of these things and are still experiencing problems decoding your
bar codes, please contact Symbol Technologies Technical Support Center. Refer to Symbol
Support Center on page xv for contact information.
Battery Implications While Using the Laser Scanner
If your battery becomes low while the scanning application is active, the scanning
application deactivates and you receive the message, “Battery Low Error”. The remaining
desktop applications continue to work until you receive further low battery warnings. You
should perform a HotSync at this point to avoid data loss. If you attempt to scan when your
battery is low, you receive the message, “Your battery level is too low for scanning”.
Recharge the battery and attempt scanning again.
15-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
15-10
Chapter 16
Installing and Removing Applications
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Removing Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Removing the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16-3
16-3
16-6
16-7
16-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
16-2
Installing and Removing Applications
Introduction
This chapter explains how to install and remove applications on your SPT 1800 terminal
and how to remove the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software from your computer.
Installing Applications
Your SPT 1800 terminal comes with the Date Book, Address Book, To Do List, Memo Pad
and Calculator applications installed and ready to use. You can also install additional
applications on your SPT 1800 terminal. The SPT Install Tool makes it quick and easy to
install software on your SPT 1800 terminal during a HotSync operation.
Note: Any application that you install on your SPT 1800 terminal resides in
RAM memory. A hard reset on the SPT 1800 terminal automatically
deletes these applications; you can also delete them manually.
To install software on your SPT 1800 terminal:
1. Copy the application you want to install into the Add-on subfolder in your SPT folder
on your computer.
Note: If you prefer to copy the application into another folder, navigate to
that folder before you complete step 5.
16-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
2. Double-click the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop icon on your Windows desktop (or
select Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop from the Start menu) to open the Symbol
Palm Terminal Desktop software.
3. Click the Install button to open the SPT Install Tool screen.
16-4
Installing and Removing Applications
Tip: You can also access the Install Tool dialog by selecting Install Tool from the
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop program group or by double-clicking any file with
a prc file extension.
4. Select the user name that corresponds to your SPT 1800 terminal in the User dropdown list.
5. Click the Add button to open the Open dialog.
6. Click the application(s) that you want to install on your SPT 1800 terminal.
7. Click the Open button to return to the Install Tool dialog.
16-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: Review the list of applications you selected in the Install Tool dialog.
If you do not want to install an application, click it, then click the
Remove button. (This does not remove the application from your
computer, it simply removes it from the list of applications to install.)
8. Perform a local HotSync operation to install the application(s) you selected. Refer
to Conducting a Local HotSync Operation on page 10-9 for details.
Removing Applications
If you run out of memory or decide that you no longer need an application you installed, you
can remove applications from your SPT 1800 terminal. You can remove only add-on
applications, patches and extensions that you install; you cannot remove the applications
that reside in the ROM portion of your SPT 1800 terminal, including Date Book, Address
Book, To Do List, Memo Pad and Calculator applications. To remove an add-on application:
1. Tap the
icon on the SPT 1800 terminal screen to open the Applications
Launcher.
2. Tap the
icon on the SPT 1800 terminal screen to open the Applications
Launcher menus.
3. Tap Delete from the App menu to open the Delete screen.
4. Tap the application that you want to remove.
5. Tap the Delete button to display a confirmation message.
Note: If you change your mind and do not want to delete an application, do
not select an application and tap Done.
16-6
Installing and Removing Applications
6. Tap the Yes button to indicate that you want to remove the application from your
SPT 1800 terminal.
7. Tap the Done button to close the Delete screen and return to the Applications
Launcher.
Removing the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
Software
If you no longer want to use the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software, you can remove
it from your computer. To remove the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software:
1. Select Settings, then Control Panel from the Start menu to open the Windows
Control Panel.
2. Double-click the Add/Remove Programs icon.
3. On the Install/Uninstall tab, select Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop from the list.
4. Click the Add/Remove button.
5. Click Yes to confirm that you want to remove the application.
16-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
16-8
Chapter 17
Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-3
Displaying Online Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-3
Symbol Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
SPT 1800 Diagnostics Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
System Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-5
Bar Code Scanner Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-6
Serial Port Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-7
Digitizer Alignment Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-8
System Diagnostics Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-8
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-9
Technical Support, Service and Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-15
Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-15
17-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
17-2
Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Introduction
There are several ways to get help with your SPT 1800 terminal. You can display online tips
on your SPT 1800 terminal and you can review the troubleshooting section in this chapter
and on your Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop Software CD. If you need additional
assistance, there are several ways to contact Symbol Technical Support. This chapter
provides details on each of these methods.
Displaying Online Tips
Many of the screens that display on your SPT 1800 terminal contain an online tips icon in
the upper-right corner. Online tips contain a summary of what is required by the screen,
shortcuts for using the screen or other useful information. Online tips always relate to the
function that you are currently performing with your SPT 1800 terminal.
To use the online tips:
1. Tap the
icon in the upper-right corner of a screen to open the Tips screen.
2. After you review the Tips screen, tap the Done button.
17-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Symbol Information
The Symbol Info application displays information about the SPT 1800 terminal. Tap the
Symbol Info icon to launch the application. The S24 Info screen only appears on SPT 184X
terminals.
SPT 1800 Diagnostics Utility
The SPT 1800 Diagnostics Utility is used to ensure that your SPT 1800 Terminal is
operating properly. It can also assist you in troubleshooting problems you may encounter.
The Diagnostics Utility tests the various features of the terminal, and reports whether or not
they are operating properly.
To run the Diagnostics Utility, run the Diag Application, which displays on your Terminal’s
Main Application screen. The Main Diagnostics screen has five options:
•
System Information
•
Bar Code Scanner
•
Serial Port
•
Digitizer Alignment
17-4
Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
•
System Diagnostics.
Tapping any of these options displays screens of related information.
System Information
The System Information option describes the system attributes of the terminal. Tapping this
option displays the System Information screen.
Manufacturer
The manufacturer of the terminal.
RAM Size
The amount of Random Access Memory.
RAM Free/Used
The amount of free and used Random Access
Memory.
ROM Used
The amount of free and used Read-Only
Memory.
17-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Flash ID
The serial number assigned to the unit.
User
The username of the terminal.
Battery
The voltage level of the batteries.
Bar Code Scanner Test
The Bar Code Scanner option tests the integrated scanner. Selecting the Bar Code
Scanner option displays the Bar Code Scanner Diagnostics Screen.
To test the scanner:
1. Select the Scanner Enabled checkbox.
2. Page down to the second page by pressing the down button on the terminal, or by
tapping on the arrow in the lower left corner of the screen with the stylus.
17-6
Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
3. To ensure that a specific type of bar code can be read, select the bar code types
you would like to read and tap Done.
Serial Port Test
The Serial Port option tests the terminal’s serial port by sending a test message.
To run the serial port test:
1. Place your terminal in a cradle attached to a computer.
2. Determine which communications port is used by HotSync.
Right-click on the HotSync icon in your computer’s icon tray in the lower left corner
of the screen, and choose Setup.
3. Select the Local tab and look at the setting specified for the Serial Port. You will
need this information in subsequent steps.
4. Click OK to close the window.
5. Shut down HotSync manager on the computer. Right-click on the HotSync icon in
your computer’s icon tray and select Exit.
6. On your computer, run HyperTerminal, which displays in the Accessories directory
in the Windows Programs menu.
7. Start a new connection in HyperTerminal.
8. Set the HyperTerminal session to connect directly, and specify the communications
port determined in Step 3.
9. Adjust the communications parameters in HyperTerminal and on the terminal so
they are compatible (e.g., 57,600, 8 data bits, 1 stop bits, no parity).
17-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
10. On the terminal, click the Send Msg button to send a test message string from the
terminal to HyperTerminal on the computer. You can edit the message, and can
also select the Continuous check box to send the test message multiple times.
When the serial port is functioning properly, the messages sent from the terminal
are displayed in HyperTerminal.
Digitizer Alignment Test
The Digitizer Alignment option tests the tracking of the stylus on the screen. To run this test,
tap the stylus in various places on the screen and crosshairs appear under the stylus. You
may also move the stylus continuously across the screen and the crosshairs track the
movement of the stylus.
System Diagnostics Test
The System Diagnostics option is an interactive test of all the terminal’s system features.
This test prompts you to perform different actions and listen for different sounds. The output
of the system diagnostics is a log file.
To run system diagnostics tap the Start button. You are prompted to begin. Tap OK to start
the test.
The test prompts you to press the different buttons on the terminal. Pressing the specified
button results in a series of short high-pitched sounds, denoting proper functioning.
Pressing an incorrect button or having the system timeout results in a low tone, denoting
failure.
The test then produces a series of four tones to test the speakers and prompts you, asking
whether or not you heard all the tones. If you hear all four tones, answer Yes. If you don’t
hear all the tones, answer No.
The test also prompts you to scan a bar code with the scanner. Press the OK button and
then scan an item.
System Diagnostics also performs some tests which are not interactive. It reads the system
information, tests the serial port, tests the memory, and tests the timer.
A series of tones denotes the conclusion of the test.
At this point, view the log file by tapping on View Log. This brings up the multi-page test
results log. You can scroll through the log, one page at a time, by tapping on the arrow
buttons in the lower left-hand corner of the screen. Alternately, use the scroll bar on the
right-hand side of the screen.
17-8
Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Troubleshooting
If you encounter a problem with your SPT 1800 terminal, look in this section for the
description that most closely matches the symptoms you observe and try the suggestions
listed.
Important: For troubleshooting tips not included in this handbook, refer to either the
README.TXT file or the Help Notes file located in the Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
directory. These files are also on the installation CD-ROM.
Table 17-1. Troubleshooting
Problem
Cause(s)
Solution
Installation
Symbol Palm Terminal
SPT 18000 terminal is in the
Desktop installation
cradle.
program incorrectly detects
that a modem is attached to
one of your serial ports.
Do not place your SPT 1800
terminal in the cradle while
installing the software.
Serial Cradle
LEDs do not light when the
cradle is plugged in.
Cradle is not receiving power.
Make sure the power supply is
securely connected and receiving
power.
LED does not light when the Terminal is not seated firmly in
terminal is inserted.
the cradle.
Replace the terminal in the cradle.
Attempt by the cradle to
Terminal was removed from the
HotSync the terminal failed. cradle while the LED was
blinking green.
Replace the terminal in the cradle.
This allows the cradle to attempt
another HotSync.
Terminal’s battery is dead.
Recharge the battery.
Active Error dialog box on
terminal.
Error dialog box must be cleared in
the terminal. Tap the OK button on
the terminal’s touchscreen.
17-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Table 17-1. Troubleshooting (Continued)
Problem
Cause(s)
Solution
Ethernet Cradle
The unit locks up with all
LEDs flashing red.
The unit could not configure
Hook the unit up to an Ethernet
itself, or it lost its lease on one of network with a correctly functioning
its ID addresses.
DHCP server and 6 available IP
addresses.
General Issues
SPT 1800 terminal does not Adjust the contrast control.
Recharge the battery. If your SPT
turn on.
Make sure the battery is charged 1800 terminal still does not
operate, try a soft reset; refer to
and installed properly.
Resetting Your SPT 1800 Terminal
on page 18-5 for details.
Low battery warning after
recharging the batteries.
The battery warning message
may display immediately after
recharging the battery. In
addition, if you check the battery
gauge in the Applications
Launcher immediately after
recharging the battery, the gauge
may start at “empty” and slowly
rise to “full.”
This is normal. It takes a few
minutes for the battery gauge to
accurately show the condition of
the battery.
No sound.
The System Sound option may
not be set correctly in the
General Preferences screen.
If the option is set to off, there will
be no sound. Refer to General
Preferences on page 13-13 for
more information.
No sound upon good
decode.
The System Sound option may
not be set correctly in the
General Preferences screen.
Verify that Beep on Good Decode
is set (checked) in Hardware Setup
in the Scan Demo Application.
Refer to General Preferences on
page 13-13 for more information.
SPT 1800 terminal turns
itself off.
Your SPT 1800 terminal is
designed to turn itself off after a
period of inactivity. This period
can be set at one minute, two
minutes or three minutes.
Check the “Auto-off after” setting in
the General Preferences screen,
and change the setting if you need
a longer delay before the automatic
shutoff feature activates. Refer to
General Preferences on page 1313 for more information.
17-10
Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Table 17-1. Troubleshooting (Continued)
Problem
Cause(s)
Solution
You need to use the Graffiti 2
character strokes for your SPT
1800 terminal to recognize
handwriting input with the stylus.
Refer to Writing Graffiti 2 with the
Stylus on page 3-6 for information
about how to write Graffiti 2
character strokes.
You are making the Graffiti 2
character strokes in the display
part of the screen, not on the
Graffiti 2 writing area.
Make the Graffiti 2 character
strokes in the Graffiti 2 writing area.
You are writing the strokes for
letters in the left-hand side, and
the strokes for numbers in the
right-hand side of the Graffiti 2
writing area.
Write the strokes on the proper
side of the Graffiti writing area.
Tapping the screen buttons
or icons does not activate
the corresponding feature.
The digitizer may need to be
recalibrated.
Recalibrate the digitizer. Choose
Digitizer from the Preferences
application pick list and follow the
directions on the screen.
When I tap the
nothing happens.
Not all applications or screens
have menus.
Try changing to a different
application.
SPT 1800 terminal doesn’t
recognize my handwriting.
icon,
A message displays stating You may have too many unused Delete unused memos and
that your SPT 1800 terminal records.
records. If necessary, you can save
memory is full.
these records on your computer
using the Save Backup Copy
option that displays in the Delete
screens.
Beamed data does not
transmit.
The terminals may be too far
apart.
Confirm that the SPT 1800
terminals are 1 ft. apart or less, and
that the path between the two
devices is clear of obstacles.
When receiving beamed
data an out of memory
message displays.
Your SPT 1800 terminal requires Verify the amount of free memory
at least twice the amount of
available.
memory available as the data
you are receiving. For example,
if you are receiving a 30K
application, you must have at
least 60K free.
17-11
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Table 17-1. Troubleshooting (Continued)
Problem
Cause(s)
Solution
Applications
Tapping the Today button
doesn’t display the current
date.
Your SPT 1800 terminal is not
set to the current date.
Make sure the Set Date box in the
General Preferences screen
displays the current date. Refer to
General Preferences on page 1313 for more information.
Entries seem to be missing
in various applications.
The categories pick list is set for Check the Categories pick list
a specific category.
(upper-right corner of the screen).
Choose All to display all of the
records for the application.
Security may have been set for
certain records.
Check the Security application and
make sure that the Private Records
setting is set to Show private
records.
HotSync Manager is not
running.
If HotSync Manager is running, exit
and restart it.
HotSync Operations
A Local HotSync operation
does not complete
successfully.
Make sure you selected Local from
the HotSync Manager menu or the
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop
menu.
Check the cable connection
between the SPT 1800 terminal or
cradle and the serial port on your
computer.
Try a lower baud rate setting on the
Local tab in the Setup screen.
Make sure you are not running
another program — such as
America On-line, CompuServe or
WinFax — that uses the serial port
you selected in the Setup screen.
Read the HotSync Log for the user
account for which you are
performing a HotSync operation.
17-12
Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Table 17-1. Troubleshooting (Continued)
Problem
A Modem HotSync
operation does not
complete successfully.
Cause(s)
Solution
Your modem doesn't have an
auto-off feature enabled.
Make sure your modem is on, and
that it does not shut down
automatically as part of an energysaving feature.
The Setup String in the Setup
screen configures your modem
incorrectly. Confirm that the
Speed setting in the Setup
screen is appropriate for your
modem.
You may need to select a different
Modem Type or enter a custom
Setup String. Most modems have a
Setup String that causes them to
send initial connection sounds to a
speaker. You can use these
sounds to check the modem
connection.
Make sure the modem connected
to your computer is turned on and
is connected to the outgoing phone
line.
Make sure you selected Modem
from the HotSync Manager menu.
Security
I forgot the password (SPT
1800 terminal is not locked).
You can use the Security
application to delete the password.
If you do this, your SPT 1800
terminal deletes all entries marked
as Private. However, you can
perform a HotSync operation
before you delete the password:
the HotSync process backs up all
entries, whether or not they are
marked private. Refer to Changing
or Deleting a Password on page
14-7 for details.
I forgot the password (SPT
1800 terminal is locked).
If you assign a password and lock
your SPT 1800 terminal, perform a
hard reset to continue using your
SPT 1800 terminal. Refer to
Resetting Your SPT 1800 Terminal
on page 18-5 for details.
17-13
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Memo Pad Tips
If you cannot manually arrange the order of the memos in the List screen, check the Memo
Preferences setting. Make sure that Sort by is set to Manual.
If you choose to view your memos alphabetically on Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop and
then perform a HotSync operation, the memos on your SPT 1800 terminal still appear in
the order defined in the Memo Preferences setting. In other words, the sort settings that
you use with Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop are not transferred to your SPT 1800 terminal.
Date Book Tips
In the Week View, you cannot select overlapping events that have the same start time. If
you have two or more events with the same start time, choose the Day View for the
particular day to see the overlapping events.
17-14
Getting Help With Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Technical Support, Service and Repair
If you have a problem using your SPT 1800 terminal, make sure you have reviewed the
following:
•
The Troubleshooting on page 17-9.
•
The README file and Help Notes located in the folder where you installed the
Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software on your computer (or on your installation
CD)
•
The Symbol Palm Terminal Desktop software Online Help.
For further assistance, contact your regional technical support office by e-mail, phone or
fax. Before requesting support, experiment a bit to reproduce and isolate the problem.
When you do contact support, be ready to provide the following information:
•
The version of Windows you are using
•
The actual error message or state you are experiencing
•
The steps you take to reproduce the problem.
Technical Support
Refer to Symbol Support Center on page xv for the Technical Support number in your
country.
17-15
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
17-16
Chapter 18
Maintaining Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Chapter Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Caring for Your SPT 1800 Terminal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Resetting Your SPT 1800 Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Performing a Soft Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Performing a Hard Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19-3
19-3
19-3
19-5
19-5
19-5
18-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
18-2
Maintaining Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Introduction
This chapter provides information to help you take proper care of your SPT 1800 terminal
and prolong battery life. It also discusses how to reset your SPT 1800 terminal.
Caring for Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Your SPT 1800 terminal is designed to be reliable and to provide years of trouble-free
service. However, you should observe the following tips when using your SPT 1800
terminal:
•
Take care not to scratch the screen of your SPT 1800. When working with your SPT
1800, use the supplied stylus or plastic-tipped pens intended for use with a touchsensitive screen. Never use an actual pen, pencil or other sharp metallic object on
the surface of the SPT 1800 screen.
•
Although your SPT 1800 is water and dust resistant, it should not be exposed to
rain or moisture for an extended period of time. In general, treat your SPT 1800 as
you would a pocket calculator or other small electronic instrument.
•
The touch-sensitive screen of your SPT 1800 contains a glass element. Take care
not to drop your SPT 1800 or subject it to any strong impact.
•
Protect your SPT 1800 from temperature extremes. Do not leave your SPT 1800
on the dashboard of a car on a hot day, and keep it away from heaters and other
heat sources.
•
Do not store or use your SPT 1800 in any location that is extremely dusty, damp or
wet.
•
Use a soft lens cloth to clean your SPT 1800. If the surface of the SPT 1800 screen
becomes soiled, clean it with a soft cloth moistened with diluted isopropyl alcohol
(rubbing alcohol).
Battery Considerations
Please note the following considerations when charging the battery in your SPT 1800
terminal:
•
Under normal conditions, your SPT 1800 terminal battery should provide
approximately 8 hours of use before the battery requires recharge. You can
conserve battery life by minimizing the use of the backlight feature, and selecting
the “Auto-off after” setting that automatically turns the SPT 1800 terminal off after
a period of inactivity (Refer to General Preferences on page 13-13).
18-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Note: When the scanner is in use, battery life is shorter, and depends on
the number of scans performed per minute.
•
If the battery becomes low while using the scanner application, the scanner
application de-activates, and you receive the message, “Battery low error”. The
other functions still work until another low battery alert occurs. When the scanner
de-activates, perform a HotSync synchronization to back up your data before
charging the battery to prevent data loss. If you try to scan when your battery is low,
you receive the message, “Your battery is too low for scanning”. When you receive
this message, recharge your battery and attempt scanning again.
•
Similarly, if the battery becomes low in the course of normal use, an alert displays
on the terminal screen describing the low battery condition. The message you
receive is, “Your batteries are low. Place the handheld in a hotsync cradle to
recharge”. If this alert displays, perform a HotSync synchronization to back up your
data before you charge the battery. As the battery life becomes extremely low, you
receive the message, “Your batteries are extremely low. Place the handheld in a
hotsync cradle to recharge”.
•
If you remove the battery, the built-in backup power of your SPT 1800 terminal
maintains memory data for a period of up to 10 minutes. Whenever you remove
the battery, replace it with a fully charged spare battery immediately. If you
encounter any difficulties in the course of battery replacement, reinstall the original
battery and wait a few minutes for the backup power to recharge.
•
If the battery drains to the point where your SPT 1800 terminal does not operate, it
stores your data safely for an indefinite period of time. In this case, there is enough
residual energy in the battery to store the data, but not enough to turn on your SPT
1800 terminal. If your SPT 1800 terminal does not turn on when you press the red
power button, charge the battery immediately.
•
If you leave a drained battery in your SPT 1800 terminal for an extended period of
time, you can lose all of the stored data. If this happens, replace the battery and
use the reset button to reset your SPT 1800 terminal. (Refer to Resetting Your SPT
1800 Terminal on page 18-5.) After you reset your SPT 1800 terminal, perform a
HotSync operation to restore the data from your computer.
•
If your battery becomes low while the terminal is still associated with a WAN, the
terminal disconnects from the network. Recharge the battery using the cradle or
the synchronization/charging cable, then reassociate with the network.
18-4
Maintaining Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Resetting Your SPT 1800 Terminal
Under normal circumstances, you will never have to use the reset button. However, on rare
occasions your SPT 1800 terminal may “hang” (no longer respond to buttons or the
screen). In this case, perform a reset to get your SPT 1800 terminal running again.
Performing a Soft Reset
A soft reset tells your SPT 1800 terminal to stop what it’s doing and start over again. All
records and entries stored in your SPT 1800 terminal are retained with a soft reset. After a
soft reset, the Palm Computing Platform Logo screen displays followed by the General
Preferences screen.
To perform a soft reset, remove the battery cover and use your stylus to gently press the
reset button, which is located under the battery cover.
Reset button
Performing a Hard Reset
A hard reset tells your SPT 1800 terminal to start over again and erase all records and
entries stored in your SPT 1800 terminal. Therefore, never perform a hard reset unless a
soft reset does not solve your problem.
Note: You can restore any data previously synchronized with your
computer during the next HotSync operation.
18-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
To perform a hard reset:
1. Open and remove the battery cover.
2. Hold down the power button on the front of the SPT 1800 terminal.
3. While holding down the power button, use the tip of the stylus to gently press the
reset button on the back of the terminal.
4. Release the reset button.
5. Release the power button.
6. When a message displays on the SPT 1800 terminal screen warning that you are
about to erase all the data stored on your SPT 1800 terminal, do one of the
following:
•
Press the upper half of either of the scroll buttons on the front panel of the SPT
1800 terminal to complete the hard reset and display the Digitizer screen.
•
Press any other button to perform a soft reset.
Note: With a hard reset, the current date and time are retained. Formats
Preferences and other settings are restored to their factory default
settings.
18-6
Appendix A
Non-ASCII Characters for Login Scripts
Introduction
The following information enables you to create custom login scripts that require non-ASCII
characters. It is provided for advanced users who understand the use and requirements of
such characters in a custom login script.
Use of ^char
You may use the caret (^) to transmit ASCII command characters. If you send ^char, and
the ASCII value of char is between @ and _, then the character is automatically translated
to a single-byte value between 0 and 31. For example, ^M is converted to a carriage return.
If char is a value between a and z, the character sequence is translated to a single-byte
value between 1 and 26. If char is any other value, the character sequence is not subject
to any special processing.
For example, the string “Joe^M” transmits Joe, followed by a carriage return.
Carriage Return and Line Feed
You may include carriage return and line feed commands as part of the login script, when
entered in the following format:
<cr>Sends or receives a carriage return
<lf>Sends or receives a line feed
A-1
SPT 1800 Product Reference Guide
For example, the string “waitfor Joe<cr><lf>” waits to receive Joe followed by a carriage
return and line feed from the remote computer before executing the next command in the
script.
Literal Characters
The backslash (\) character defines that the next character is transmitted as a literal
character, and is not subject to any special processing ordinarily associated with that
character.
Examples:
\^Includes a caret as part of the string
\<Includes a < as part of the string
\\Includes a backslash as part of the string
A-2
Appendix B
Installing the Multi-Language Operating
System
Introduction
This section provides the procedures for installing the multi-language Operating System
onto the SPT 1800 terminal. The ROM image will contain the following languages:
•
English
•
French
•
Italian
•
German
•
Spanish.
Download the Operating System
Go to http://devzone.symbol.com to download the flashtool that contains the multilanguage ROM image.
Download the Desktop Software
The SPT Palm Desktop Software is available in English, French, Italian, German and
Spanish. Go to http://devzone.symbol.com to download the SPT Palm OS Desktop
Software.
B-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Installation
To install the ROM image:
1. Connect the terminal to the host computer.
2. Perform a HotSync operation to backup all data and applications that you want to
preserve.
3. Copy the downloaded flash tool file to a directory where you will be running the
flash tool.
4. Copy CondMgr.dll file to the directory where you will be running the flash tool.
5. Run the flash tool application. The Welcome screen appears.
B-2
Installing the Multi-Language Operating System
6. Click on the Advanced button. The Advanced Mode screen appears.
7. Place the terminal in the debug mode.
a. Remove the battery door.
b. Hold down the down scroll button and press and release the reset button.
c. The terminal screen becomes unreadable with a blinking square in the top left
corner.
d. Replace the battery door.
8. Place the terminal in the cradle or connect the HotSync cable.
9. Click the Next button. The Palm OS Software Upgrade Utility screen appears.
B-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
10. Click the Yes button. The Palm OS Upgrade Progress screen appears.
Caution
Do not remove the terminal from the cradle or cable during the upgrade
process.
11. The software installation begins.
B-4
Installing the Multi-Language Operating System
12. The Restore Data dialog box appears.
B-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
13. Use the stylus and tap the targets on the terminal screen. The Select Language
screen appears.
14. Select a language.
15. Tap the OK button.
16. Ensure that you are running the correct Desktop Software. For example, if you
selected French on the terminal the French Desktop Software must be running on
the computer.
17. Tap the Yes button.
18. Follow the instructions on the screen to set the time, time zone and date.
19. Run Hotsync. After HotSync is complete, tap the Reset button to reset the terminal.
B-6
Installing the Multi-Language Operating System
20. In the Restore Your Data screen, click on the Next button. The Congratulations
screen appears.
21. Click the Close button.
Switching Between Languages
Once the multi-language operating system is installed, you can switch between languages
on the terminal. To switch between language:
1. Perform a hard reset (refer to Performing a Hard Reset on page 18-5).
2. The terminal resets. When the Palm logo appears, release the power button.
B-7
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
3. A message requesting to erase all data appears. Press the Up scroll button to
erase all data and continue or press any other button to cancel.
4. After reset, the following screen appears:
5. Use the stylus to tap the center of the target. Two more target screens appear.
6. Use the stylus to tap the center of each target. The Select Language screen
appears:
7. Tap the language that you want to appear on the terminal. Tap the OK button.
B-8
Installing the Multi-Language Operating System
8. To ensure that data is not lost, the desktop software language of the host computer
must match the language that you have selected on the terminal. Tap Yes to
continue or tap No to go back to the previous screen.
9. The terminal resets and the setup screen appears in the language you selected.
French
Italian
B-9
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
German
B-10
Spanish
Index
Numerics
128-bit encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
128-bit Shared Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
40-bit encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
40-bit Shared Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
A
access point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Address Book
beaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
business card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
categories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
creating entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
entry details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
list by company . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
lookup entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
phone numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
AirBEAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1
Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4
Configuring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4
Package Builder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3
Synchronization with Server . . . . . . . 12-9
AirBEAM configuration
Misc(1) tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-7
Misc(2) tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9
Packages(1) tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5
Packages(2) tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5
Server tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6
Alarm
setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Applications
Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . xii, 7-1, 7-3
Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1, 5-3
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4
special buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Date Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xii, 6-1, 6-3
agenda view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
Changing the View . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Deleting an Event . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
event conflicts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
Marking Private Event . . . . . . . . 6-12
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
month view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
Repeat Function . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Rescheduling an Event . . . . . . . . 6-8
Scheduling an Event . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Scheduling Repeating Events . . 6-10
Setting Alarm for an Event . . . . . . 6-8
Working in Agenda View . . . . . . 6-16
Working in Week View . . . . . . . . 6-13
Demo Scan Application
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-6
font style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1, 10-10, 10-13
CDPD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20
Conducting locally . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
conducting via modem . . . . . . . 10-14
performing for first time . . . . . . . 10-3
preparing your computer for . . 10-14
Selecting HotSync Setup
Options . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Spectrum24 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
Index-1
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-3
Installing and Removing . . . . . . . . . . 16-1
Laser Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-1
Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Memo Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1, 8-3
Arranging Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
choosing a memo category . . . . . 8-6
Deleting a Memo . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
marking a memo private . . . . . . . 8-6
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
reviewing memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-1
buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3
changing pen preferences . . . . . 13-5
Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7
Digitizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13, 13-14
hotsync buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Owner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-29
owner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-29
pen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-30
time,date, week,numbers . . . . 13-10
Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-6
Scout Sync Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1
Configuring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1
setting preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
SScan Application
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3
switching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
To Do List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
choosing a to do category . . . . . . 9-7
setting a due date . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
To Do Show Options . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Working with items . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
B
Batteries
Index-2
auto-off delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13
battery considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-3
Beaming
Address Book categories . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Address Book entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
business card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
Business Card
beaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
selecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
C
Calculator
buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
menu commands
recent calculations . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Calculator Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Categories
Address Book entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
beaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
CDPD . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12, 2-11, 2-23, 10-20
Changing the Date Book View . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Conducting a HotSync Operation
via Modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Conducting a local HotSync Operation . . . 10-9
Conduits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
Connection Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-15
contacting Symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Creating
Address Book entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Customizing HotSync Application
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
D
Data Encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
date
setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
Date Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Changing the view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Deleting an Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
event conflicts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
event duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Index
event start time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Marking Private Event . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
month view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
private events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
repeat event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Rescheduling an Event . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
rescheduling events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Scheduling an Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
scheduling event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Scheduling Repeating Events . . . . . . 6-10
Setting an Alarm for an event . . . . . . . 6-8
switching views . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
untimed event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
week view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Working in Agenda View . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
Working in Week View . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
decrypting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4, 2-10
Deleting an Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Demo Scan Application
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-6
Details
Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
E
encrypting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4, 2-10
Entries
Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
beaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Ethernet Cradle
Configuring Remote Host PC . . . . . 10-23
HotSync Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Ethernet cradle
installing NetSync
options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
Event
changing to untimed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
conflicts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
Date Book scheduling . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
deleting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
in week view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14
private . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
repeat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
setting alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
start and duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
untimed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
F
File Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
Finding
Address Book entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
Finding information with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
G
Getting Help with your SPT 1800 Terminal 17-1
Graffiti 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
punctuation marks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
ShortCuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
Graffiti 2 Help
pen stroke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
H
handstrap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6, 17-7, 18-4
CDPD wireless . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20
conducting a local operation . . . . . . . 10-9
conducting wireless operations . . . . 10-18
conduits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
customizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
customizing application settings . . . 10-12
Ethernet cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
installing NetSync . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
File Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
HotSync Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
local . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
modem conduit setup . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16
modem settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11
options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
performing for first time . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
preparing your computer for modem 10-14
Index-3
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
Setting up for wireless . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Spectrum24 wireless . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
user profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
using a modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
using File Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
I
IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-21
K
Kerberos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4, 2-9
Kerberos Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Keyboard
pen stroke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
L
Laser Pointer Application
using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-9
Laser Scanner
battery implications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-9
Look Up
Address Book entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
M
magnetic stripe reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
Marking a Private Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Memo Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3, 8-4
arranging memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
creating new . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4
deleting memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
reviewing memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Menus
Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Date Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
Modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15, 13-6, 13-15
HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
modem conduit setup . . . . . . . 10-16
Month
Date Book view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
Index-4
N
Network
password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16
primary DNS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-23
TCP/IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Network Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Configuring CDPD WAN . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Setup Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
Configuring Spectrum24 . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
New
Address Book entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Non-ASCII Characters for Login
Scripts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1, B-1
notational conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
O
Open System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4, 2-9
Owner Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-29
P
Palm Desktop
customizing HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
HotSync options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
system requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
passwords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Performing a CDPD HotSync . . . . . . . . . 10-20
Performing a Spectrum24 HotSync . . . . . 10-19
Phone Numbers
choosing type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
Power Off
pen stroke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
Preferences
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3
preferences
setting date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
ShortCuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14
Preparing for a Modem HotSync
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Private
events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
punctuation marks, writing . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
Index
R
Records
Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
beaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Removing
Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-6
Date Book events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Repeat Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
reset
hard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
soft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
S
Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3, 15-7
Barcode Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-7
Demo Scan Application . . . . . . . . . . . 15-4
scanning using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-7
problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-8
Sscan application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3
Scanning Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-8
Scheduling an Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Scheduling Repeating Events . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Scout Sync Client
Configuring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4
conduits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-17
service information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Setting Up for a Wireless HotSync . . . . . 10-18
Setting up the Ethernet Cradle
for HotSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
Shared Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
ShortCuts
creating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14
editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15
Graffiti 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
soft reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
Sorting
Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
Spectrum24 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
SPT 1800
Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
Bar Code Scanner test . . . . . . . 17-6
Digitizer Alignment test . . . . . . . 17-8
Serial Port test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-7
system information test . . . . . . . 17-5
Systems Diagnostics test . . . . . 17-8
hard reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
Maintaining your terminal . . . . . . . . . 18-1
caring for . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-3
online tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-3
Parts of the SPT 1800 . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
resetting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
soft reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
Scanning with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3
SPT 1800 Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
SPT 1800 terminal
Getting Help with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-1
stylus
replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
tapping versus clicking . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
Symbol info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
symbol support center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
T
tapping, using stylus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
TCP/IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Time
alarm setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
setting event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
To Do List
menu commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
trigger handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
U
Untimed Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
User Profile
using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
V
vehicle charging adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
vehicle cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
Index-5
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
W
warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WEP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WEP Encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wired Equivalent Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Index-6
xvii
2-4
2-4
2-4
Wireless HotSync Operations . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Working in Agenda View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
Working in Month View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
Working in Week View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Working with Your SPT 1800 Terminal . . . . 3-1
Tell Us What You Think...
We’d like to know what you think about this Manual. Please take a moment
to fill out this questionnaire and fax this form to: (631) 738-3318, or mail to:
Symbol Technologies, Inc.
One Symbol Plaza M/S B-4
Holtsville, NY 11742-1300
Attention: Technical Publications Manager
IMPORTANT: If you need product support, please call the appropriate
customer support number provided. Unfortunately, we cannot provide
customer support at the fax number above.
User’s Manual Title:___________________________________________
(please include revision level)
How familiar were you with this product before using this manual?
Very familiar
Slightly familiar
Not at all familiar
Did this manual meet your needs? If not, please explain.
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
What topics need to be added to the index, if applicable?
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
What topics do you feel need to be better discussed? Please be specific.
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
What can we do to further improve our manuals?
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
SPT 1800 Series Product Reference Guide
72-51337-06
Revision A — March 2003
Symbol Technologies, Inc. One Symbol Plaza, Holtsville N.Y. 11742-1300
http://www.symbol.com/manuals